]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
*** empty log message ***
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ** Emacs includes now support for loading image libraries on demand.
21 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
22 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
23 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
24
25 ---
26 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
27 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
28 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
29 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
30 select the right one.
31
32 ---
33 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
34 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
35 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
36
37 ---
38 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
39
40 ---
41 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
42
43 ---
44 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
45 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
46 installed programs.
47
48 ---
49 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
50 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
51 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
52 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
53 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
54 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
55 in each user's home directory.
56
57 ---
58 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
59 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
60 Emacs with Leim.
61
62 +++
63 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
64
65 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
66 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
67 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
68 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
69
70 ---
71 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
72 the distribution.
73
74 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
75 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
76 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
77 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
78
79 ---
80 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
81
82 ---
83 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
84
85 ---
86 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
87
88 ---
89 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
90 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
94
95 ---
96 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
97 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
98 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
99
100 ---
101 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
102
103 ---
104 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
105 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
106
107 \f
108 * Changes in Emacs 22.1
109
110 +++
111 ** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
112 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
113 but declared obsolete.
114
115 ** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
116 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
117 following should work:
118 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
119 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
120 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
121
122 ** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
123 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
124 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
125 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
126 M-f (forward-word)
127 M-b (backward-word)
128 M-d (kill-word)
129 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
130 M-t (transpose-words)
131 M-q (fill-paragraph)
132
133 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
134
135 ---
136 ** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
137 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
138 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
139 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
140 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
141
142 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
143
144 ---
145 ** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
146 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
147 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
148 This change may result in using the different coding systems as
149 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
150
151 +++
152 ** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
153 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
154 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
155 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
156 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
157 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
158
159 +++
160 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
161 M-o M-o requests refontification.
162
163 +++
164 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
165
166 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
167 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
168 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
169
170 +++
171 ** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
172 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
173 The default value is 1.
174
175 +++
176 ** C-u M-x goto-line now switches to the most recent previous buffer,
177 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
178
179 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
180 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
181
182 ---
183 ** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
184 display margin, when run in an xterm.
185
186 +++
187 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
188 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
189
190 +++
191 ** Control characters and escape glyphs are now shown in the new
192 escape-glyph face.
193
194 +++
195 ** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
196 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
197 to nil.
198
199 ---
200 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
201 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
202 you don't want the .type-break file in your home directory or are
203 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
204
205 ---
206 ** display-battery has been replaced by display-battery-mode.
207
208 ---
209 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode, which is available when
210 `calculator-output-radix' is non-nil. In this mode a separator
211 character is used every few digits, making it easier to see byte
212 boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the variable
213 `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
214
215 +++
216 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
217
218 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
219 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
220 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
221 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
222 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior.
223
224 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs may do much
225 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
226 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
227 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
228 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
229 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
230 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
231 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
232 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
233
234 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
235 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
236 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
237 you release it).
238
239 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
240 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
241
242 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
243 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
244
245 +++
246 ** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
247
248 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
249 when visiting the file.
250
251 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
252 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
253 when saving the file.
254
255 +++
256 ** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
257 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
258 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
259 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
260 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
261 modes do.
262
263 +++
264 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
265 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
266 you about it.
267
268 +++
269 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
270
271 +++
272 ** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
273 of the file that precede the first header line.
274
275 +++
276 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
277 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
278 and `C-c C-r'.
279
280 +++
281 ** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
282 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
283
284 +++
285 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
286 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
287
288 ---
289 ** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
290
291 +++
292 ** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
293 for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
294 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
295 specified by the syntax table.
296 ---
297 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
298
299 +++
300 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
301 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
302 existing values. For example:
303
304 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
305
306 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
307 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
308
309 ---
310 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved, it can
311 run most curses applications now.
312
313 ** New features in evaluation commands
314
315 +++
316 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
317 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
318
319 +++
320 *** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
321 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
322 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
323 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
324 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
325
326 ---
327 ** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
328 characters.
329
330 +++
331 ** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
332 in the current input method to input a character at point.
333
334 +++
335 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
336 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
337 can be used as well.
338
339 ---
340 ** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
341 C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
342
343 ---
344 ** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
345 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
346 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
347 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
348
349 ---
350 ** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
351 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
352 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
353 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
354 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
355
356 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
357 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
358
359 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
360 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
361 lines, including any prompts.
362
363 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
364 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
365 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
366 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
367 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
368 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
369 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
370
371 +++
372 ** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
373 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
374
375 +++
376 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
377
378 +++
379 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
380
381 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
382 the fancy startup screen.
383
384 +++
385 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
386
387 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
388 the blinking cursor.
389
390 +++
391 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
392 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
393
394 +++
395 ** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
396 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
397
398 ---
399 ** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
400 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
401 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
402
403 +++
404 ** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
405 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
406 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
407 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
408 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
409 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
410 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
411 be mode dependent.
412
413 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
414 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
415 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
416 toggles this mode.
417
418 +++
419 ** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
420 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
421 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
422 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
423 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
424 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
425 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
426 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
427 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
428
429 +++
430 ** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
431 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
432 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
433 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
434 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
435
436 +++
437 ** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
438 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
439 mode.
440
441 ---
442 ** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
443
444 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
445 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
446 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
447 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
448
449 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
450 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
451 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
452
453 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
454 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
455 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
456 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
457 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
458
459 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
460
461 ** Compilation mode enhancements:
462
463 +++
464 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
465 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
466 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
467 subprocesses inherit.
468
469 +++
470 ** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
471
472 ---
473 *** There's a new separate package grep.el.
474
475 ---
476 *** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
477
478 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
479 can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
480
481 ---
482 *** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
483
484 +++
485 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
486 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
487
488 ---
489 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
490 `grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
491 compilation mode settings for grep commands.
492
493 +++
494 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
495 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
496 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
497 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
498 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
499 source line is highlighted.
500
501 +++
502 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
503 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
504 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
505 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
506 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
507 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
508 file.
509
510 +++
511 ** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
512 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
513 in new face `next-error'.
514
515 +++
516 ** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
517 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
518 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
519 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
520 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
521 C-c C-f.
522
523 +++
524 ** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
525
526 +++
527 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
528 resync points in both windows.
529
530 ---
531 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
532 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
533 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
534 using strokes as an input method.
535
536 ** Gnus package
537
538 ---
539 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
540 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
541 PGP/MIME.
542
543 ---
544 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
545 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
546
547 +++
548 ** Desktop package
549
550 +++
551 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
552 desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
553 saving.
554
555 ---
556 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
557 buffer list.
558
559 +++
560 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers immediately,
561 remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
562
563 +++
564 *** New commands:
565 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
566 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
567 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
568 it was loaded.
569 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
570 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
571
572 ---
573 *** New customizable variables:
574 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
575 killed.
576 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
577 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
578 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
579 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
580 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
581 should not delete.
582 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
583 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
584 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
585 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
586
587 +++
588 *** New command line option --no-desktop
589
590 ---
591 *** New hooks:
592 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
593 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
594
595 ---
596 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
597 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
598 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
599 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
600 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
601 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
602 feature.
603
604 +++
605 ** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
606
607 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
608 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
609 % emacsclient -s foo file1
610 % emacsclient -s bar file2
611
612 +++
613 ** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
614 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
615 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
616 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
617 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
618
619 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
620 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
621
622 +++
623 ** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
624 now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
625 down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
626 right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
627
628 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
629 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
630 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
631
632 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
633 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
634
635 Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
636 of each bitmap individually.
637
638 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
639 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
640 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
641 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
642
643 +++
644 ** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
645 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
646 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
647 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
648 keyboard oriented alternative.
649
650 +++
651 ** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
652 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
653 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
654 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
655 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
656
657 ---
658 ** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
659 move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
660 non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
661 echo area, using `display-local-help'.
662
663 +++
664 ** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
665 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
666 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
667 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
668 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
669 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
670 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
671
672 +++
673 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
674 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
675
676 +++
677 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
678 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
679 an interactively callable function.
680
681 ---
682 ** sql changes.
683
684 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
685 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
686 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
687 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
688 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
689
690 The following values are supported:
691
692 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
693 db2 DB2
694 informix Informix
695 ingres Ingres
696 interbase Interbase
697 linter Linter
698 ms Microsoft
699 mysql MySQL
700 oracle Oracle
701 postgres Postgres
702 solid Solid
703 sqlite SQLite
704 sybase Sybase
705
706 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
707 SQL mode indicator.
708
709 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
710 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
711 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
712
713 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
714
715 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
716 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
717 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
718 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
719
720 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
721 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
722
723 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
724 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
725 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
726
727 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
728 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
729 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
730 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
731 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
732 terminated.
733
734 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
735 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
736 credentials to authenticate the user.
737
738 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
739 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
740 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
741
742 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
743 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
744
745 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
746 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
747 defaults.
748
749 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
750 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
751 `sql-product'.
752
753 ---
754 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
755 with special modes such as Tar mode.
756
757 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
758
759 +++
760 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
761 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
762 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
763 available.
764
765 +++
766 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
767 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
768 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
769 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
770 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
771 matching item.
772
773 +++
774 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
775 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
776 the operating system or your X server.
777
778 ---
779 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
780 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
781 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
782
783 ---
784 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
785 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
786
787 ---
788 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
789 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
790
791 +++
792 ** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
793 list starting after point.
794
795 ** Dired mode:
796
797 ---
798 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
799 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
800 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
801
802 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
803 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
804
805 +++
806 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
807 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
808
809 +++
810 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
811 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
812 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
813 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
814 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
815 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
816
817 +++
818 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
819 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
820
821 +++
822 ** Dired-x:
823
824 +++
825 *** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
826 command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to M-O,
827 marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
828 mode toggling function instead.
829
830 +++
831 ** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
832 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
833
834 +++
835 ** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
836 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
837
838 ** FFAP
839
840 +++
841 *** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
842 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
843 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
844 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
845
846 ---
847 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
848 it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
849 multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
850
851 ** Info mode:
852
853 +++
854 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
855 with the number appended to the *info* buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
856
857 ---
858 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
859 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
860 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
861 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
862 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
863 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
864 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
865 Info node.
866
867 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
868 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
869 search without prompting for a new search string.
870
871 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
872 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
873 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
874
875 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
876
877 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
878 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
879
880 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
881 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
882 possible matches.
883
884 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
885 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
886 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
887
888 ---
889 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
890 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
891
892 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
893 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
894
895 +++
896 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
897 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
898 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
899
900 ---
901 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
902 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
903 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
904 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
905
906 +++
907 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
908
909 ---
910 *** Info-index offers completion.
911
912 ---
913 ** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
914 'sql-sqlite'.
915
916 ** BibTeX mode:
917 *** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
918 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
919
920 *** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
921 an existing BibTeX entry.
922
923 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
924
925 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
926 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
927 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
928 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
929 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
930 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
931
932 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
933 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
934
935 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
936 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
937
938 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
939 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
940
941 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
942 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
943
944 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
945 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
946 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
947
948 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
949 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
950
951 *** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
952 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
953
954 *** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
955 in multiple BibTeX files.
956
957 *** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
958 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
959
960 +++
961 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
962 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
963 at the edges of the window.
964
965 +++
966 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
967 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
968
969 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
970 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
971 or when the frame is resized.
972
973 +++
974 ** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
975
976 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
977 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
978
979 +++
980 ** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
981 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
982 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
983
984 +++
985 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
986
987 +++
988 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
989 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
990
991 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
992 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
993
994 +++
995 ** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
996
997 +++
998 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
999
1000 ---
1001 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
1002 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
1003
1004 +++
1005 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
1006 Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
1007
1008 ---
1009 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1010
1011 ---
1012 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
1013 and other common debugger commands.
1014
1015 ---
1016 ** recentf changes.
1017
1018 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
1019 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
1020 automatic cleanup.
1021
1022 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
1023 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
1024 keep in the recent list.
1025
1026 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
1027 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
1028 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
1029 recent list with different symbolic links.
1030
1031 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
1032 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
1033 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
1034
1035 +++
1036 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
1037 from the locale.
1038
1039 +++
1040 ** Init file changes
1041
1042 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
1043 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
1044
1045 ---
1046 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
1047
1048 ---
1049 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
1050 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
1051 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
1052 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
1053 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
1054 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
1055
1056 ---
1057 ** MH-E changes.
1058
1059 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
1060 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
1061
1062 +++
1063 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
1064 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
1065 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
1066
1067 +++
1068 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
1069
1070 +++
1071 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
1072 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
1073 appears between the position information and the major mode.
1074
1075 +++
1076 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
1077 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
1078
1079 +++
1080 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
1081 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
1082 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
1083 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
1084 set-fringe-style.
1085
1086 +++
1087 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
1088 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
1089 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
1090 "~/".
1091
1092 +++
1093 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
1094 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
1095 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
1096 file.)
1097
1098 +++
1099 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1100 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1101
1102 +++
1103 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1104 of a file.
1105
1106 ---
1107 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
1108
1109 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
1110 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
1111 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
1112
1113 ---
1114 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1115 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1116 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1117
1118 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1119 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1120 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1121 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1122 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1123
1124 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1125 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1126 t, and the status is shown.
1127
1128 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1129 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1130
1131 +++
1132 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1133 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1134 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1135 faces.
1136
1137 ---
1138 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1139 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1140 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1141 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1142 automatically according to the locale.)
1143
1144 ---
1145 ** Indian support has been updated.
1146 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1147 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1148 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1149 supported.
1150
1151 ---
1152 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1153 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1154 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1155 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1156 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1157 tamil-inscript.
1158
1159 ---
1160 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1161 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1162 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1163
1164 ---
1165 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1166 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1167 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1168 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1169 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1170 latter is used by GNU locales.
1171
1172 ---
1173 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1174 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1175 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1176 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1177 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1178 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1179 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1180 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1181 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1182 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1183 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1184 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1185
1186 ---
1187 ** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1188 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1189
1190 ---
1191 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1192 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1193 fontset appropriately.
1194
1195 ---
1196 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1197 unicode.
1198
1199 +++
1200 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1201 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1202 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1203 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1204 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1205 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1206 mule-unicode-... ones.
1207
1208 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1209 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1210 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1211 possible.
1212
1213 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1214 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1215 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1216 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1217 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1218
1219 ---
1220 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1221 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1222 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1223 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1224
1225 +++
1226 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1227 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1228 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1229 command.
1230
1231 ---
1232 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1233 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1234 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1235
1236 ---
1237 ** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
1238 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
1239
1240 +++
1241 ** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
1242 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
1243 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
1244
1245 ---
1246 ** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
1247 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
1248
1249 ---
1250 ** Dialogs and menus pop down when pressing C-g.
1251
1252 ---
1253 ** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
1254 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
1255 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
1256
1257 +++
1258 ** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
1259 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
1260
1261 +++
1262 ** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
1263 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
1264 the new dialog.
1265
1266 +++
1267 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
1268 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
1269 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
1270 cursor does.
1271
1272 +++
1273 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
1274 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
1275
1276 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1277 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1278 program files that include other program files.
1279
1280 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1281 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1282 in them.
1283
1284 ---
1285 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1286 when Emacs visits them.
1287
1288 ---
1289 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
1290
1291 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
1292 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
1293 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
1294
1295 ---
1296 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1297 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1298 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1299 and use the more appropriately result.
1300
1301 +++
1302 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
1303 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
1304 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
1305 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
1306
1307 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
1308 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
1309 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
1310 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
1311 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
1312 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
1313
1314 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
1315 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
1316
1317 ** TeX modes:
1318
1319 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
1320
1321 +++
1322 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
1323 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
1324 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
1325 TeX commands to use at startup.
1326
1327 ---
1328 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
1329 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
1330
1331 +++
1332 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
1333
1334 +++
1335 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
1336 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
1337 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
1338 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
1339 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
1340 feature is not enabled.
1341
1342 +++
1343 ** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1344 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1345 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1346 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
1347 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
1348 to give it focus.
1349
1350 +++
1351 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
1352 description various information about a character, including its
1353 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
1354 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
1355 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
1356
1357 +++
1358 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1359 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1360 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1361 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1362 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1363
1364 +++
1365 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1366 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1367 in Indented-Text mode.
1368
1369 ---
1370 ** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
1371 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1372 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1373
1374 +++
1375 ** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
1376 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
1377 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
1378 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
1379 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
1380 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
1381 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
1382 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
1383 can be edited for each replacement.
1384
1385 +++
1386 ** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
1387 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
1388
1389 ---
1390 ** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
1391 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
1392
1393 +++
1394 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1395 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1396 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1397 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1398 also disable mouse highlighting.
1399
1400 +++
1401 ** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1402 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1403 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1404
1405 +++
1406 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1407 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1408 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1409 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1410 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1411
1412 +++
1413 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
1414 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
1415 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
1416 prompt string.
1417
1418 +++
1419 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
1420 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
1421 the mode line of the currently selected window.
1422
1423 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
1424 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
1425
1426 ---
1427 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
1428 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
1429 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
1430 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
1431 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
1432 current date and time, current line and column number in the
1433 mode-line.
1434
1435 ---
1436 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
1437
1438 +++
1439 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
1440 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
1441 `display-time-mail-directory'.
1442
1443 ---
1444 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
1445
1446 +++
1447 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
1448 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
1449 argument it toggles the mode.
1450
1451 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
1452 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
1453
1454 +++
1455 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
1456 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
1457 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
1458 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
1459 `inhibit-splash-screen').
1460
1461 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
1462
1463 +++
1464 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1465 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1466 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1467 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1468 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1469 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1470 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1471 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1472 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1473
1474 ---
1475 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1476 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1477 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1478 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1479 all of these colors.
1480
1481 +++
1482 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1483 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1484 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1485 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1486 colors as on X.
1487
1488 ---
1489 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1490
1491 +++
1492 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
1493
1494 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
1495 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
1496 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
1497 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
1498
1499 ---
1500 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
1501 automatically.
1502
1503 +++
1504 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1505 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1506 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1507 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1508
1509 +++
1510 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
1511
1512 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
1513
1514 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
1515 that do not change:
1516
1517 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
1518 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
1519
1520 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
1521 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
1522
1523 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
1524
1525 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
1526 run by the key sequence.
1527
1528 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
1529 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
1530 that command.
1531
1532 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
1533 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
1534
1535 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
1536 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
1537
1538 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
1539 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
1540
1541 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
1542 new-kill-line is on C-k
1543
1544 +++
1545 ** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
1546 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
1547 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
1548 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
1549 for details.
1550
1551 +++
1552 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
1553 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
1554 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
1555 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
1556
1557 +++
1558 ** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
1559 at the end of a line.
1560
1561 +++
1562 ** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
1563 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
1564 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
1565
1566 +++
1567 ** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
1568 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
1569 search string used as the string to replace.
1570
1571 +++
1572 ** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
1573 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
1574 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
1575
1576 +++
1577 ** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
1578 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
1579 elements are deleted.
1580
1581 +++
1582 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
1583 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
1584 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
1585 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
1586
1587 +++
1588 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1589 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1590 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1591 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1592
1593 +++
1594 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1595 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1596 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1597 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1598 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1599 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1600
1601 ---
1602 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1603 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1604 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1605 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1606 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1607 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1608 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1609
1610 +++
1611 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1612 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1613 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1614 under the "[State]" button.
1615
1616 ---
1617 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
1618 point (no integers are allowed).
1619
1620 +++
1621 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
1622 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1623
1624 ---
1625 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
1626
1627 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1628 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1629 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1630 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1631 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1632
1633 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1634 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1635 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1636 (gud-finish).
1637
1638 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1639 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1640
1641 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1642 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1643 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1644
1645 Added Customization Variables
1646
1647 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1648
1649 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1650 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1651 java sources (previous method).
1652
1653 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1654 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1655 is nil).
1656
1657 Minor Improvements
1658
1659 *** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1660 instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
1661 compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
1662 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1663 "starttls" tool).
1664
1665 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1666
1667 +++
1668 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1669 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
1670 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
1671
1672 +++
1673 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1674 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1675 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1676 is only rarely needed.
1677
1678 ---
1679 ** JIT-lock changes
1680 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
1681
1682 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
1683 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
1684 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1685 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
1686
1687 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1688
1689 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1690 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1691 refontification takes place.
1692
1693 +++
1694 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1695 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
1696 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
1697 you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
1698 This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
1699 a key. It also extends the region when the mark is active in Transient
1700 Mark mode, regardless of the last command. To start a new region with
1701 one of marking commands in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the
1702 active region with C-g, or set the new mark with C-SPC.
1703
1704 +++
1705 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1706 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1707 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1708 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
1709 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1710 command only.
1711
1712 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1713 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1714 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1715 mark or the region.
1716
1717 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1718 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1719 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1720 C-g.
1721
1722 +++
1723 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
1724 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
1725 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1726
1727 +++
1728 ** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
1729 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
1730 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
1731
1732 +++
1733 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1734 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1735 switching to it.
1736
1737 +++
1738 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1739 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1740 affects the initial frame.
1741
1742 +++
1743 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1744 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
1745 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1746 paragraphs.
1747
1748 +++
1749 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1750 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1751 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1752 directory listing into a buffer.
1753
1754 ---
1755 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1756 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1757
1758 ---
1759 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1760 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
1761 This behavior can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1762 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1763
1764 +++
1765 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1766 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1767 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1768 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1769 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1770 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1771 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1772 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1773
1774 +++
1775 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
1776 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1777 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1778 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
1779 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
1780
1781 +++
1782 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1783 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1784 appears in.
1785
1786 +++
1787 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1788 of the recognized cursor types.
1789
1790 ---
1791 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1792 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1793 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1794
1795 +++
1796 ** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
1797 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
1798
1799 +++
1800 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1801 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
1802 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
1803 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1804 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1805 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1806 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1807 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1808 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1809
1810 +++
1811 ** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1812 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1813 count backward from the end of the year.
1814
1815 +++
1816 ** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
1817 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
1818 day of that ISO week.
1819
1820 ---
1821 ** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
1822 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
1823
1824 ---
1825 ** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
1826 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
1827 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
1828 `christian-holidays' simpler.
1829
1830 ---
1831 ** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1832 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1833 and `diary-header-line-format'.
1834
1835 +++
1836 ** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1837 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1838 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1839 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1840
1841 +++
1842 ** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
1843 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
1844 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
1845 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
1846 formats.
1847
1848
1849 ** VC Changes
1850
1851 +++
1852 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1853 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1854 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1855 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1856 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1857
1858 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1859
1860 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1861
1862 +++
1863 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1864 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1865 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1866 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1867 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1868 CVS.
1869
1870 +++
1871 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1872
1873 ** EDiff changes.
1874
1875 +++
1876 *** When comparing directories.
1877 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1878 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1879 from one directory to another.
1880
1881 +++
1882 *** When comparing files or buffers.
1883 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1884 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1885 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1886 comparison.
1887
1888 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
1889 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1890 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1891
1892 +++
1893 ** Etags changes.
1894
1895 *** New regular expressions features
1896
1897 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
1898 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1899 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1900 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1901 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1902 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
1903 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1904 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1905 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1906 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1907 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1908
1909 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
1910 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1911 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1912 CR, TAB, VT,
1913
1914 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
1915 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1916 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1917 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1918
1919 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
1920 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1921 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1922
1923 *** New language parsing features
1924
1925 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1926 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1927
1928 **** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1929
1930 **** New language HTML.
1931 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1932 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1933
1934 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1935 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1936 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1937
1938 **** New language Lua.
1939 All functions are tagged.
1940
1941 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
1942 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1943 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1944 package::sub.
1945
1946 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1947
1948 **** New language PHP.
1949 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
1950 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
1951
1952 **** New default keywords for TeX.
1953 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1954 renewenvironment.
1955
1956 *** Honour #line directives.
1957 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1958 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1959 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1960 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1961 writes tags pointing to the source file.
1962
1963 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
1964 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
1965 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
1966 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
1967 the file FILE.
1968
1969 +++
1970 ** CC Mode changes.
1971
1972 *** Font lock support.
1973 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1974 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1975 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1976 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1977 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1978 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1979
1980 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1981 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1982 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1983 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1984 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1985 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1986 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1987 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1988 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1989
1990 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1991 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1992 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1993 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1994 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1995 take the better part of a minute.
1996
1997 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1998 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1999 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2000 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2001 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2002 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2003
2004 **** Support for documentation comments.
2005 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2006 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2007 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2008 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2009
2010 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
2011 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
2012 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
2013 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2014
2015 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2016 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2017 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2018 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2019 parens.
2020
2021 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2022 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2023 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2024 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2025 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2026
2027 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2028 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2029 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2030 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2031 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2032
2033 *** Support for the AWK language.
2034 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2035 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2036 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2037 Here is a summary:
2038
2039 **** Indentation Engine
2040 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2041
2042 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2043 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2044 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2045 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2046 definition, or structured statement.
2047
2048 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2049 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
2050 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2051
2052 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
2053 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
2054 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
2055 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
2056
2057 **** Font Locking
2058 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2059 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2060 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2061 the AWK language itself.
2062
2063 **** Comment Commands
2064 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
2065 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
2066
2067 **** Movement Commands
2068 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
2069 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
2070 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
2071
2072 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
2073 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
2074 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
2075 functions.
2076
2077 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2078 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2079 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2080 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
2081
2082 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2083 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2084 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2085 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2086 composition-close, and incomposition.
2087
2088 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2089 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
2090 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2091 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2092
2093 *** Better control over require-final-newline. The variable that
2094 controls how to handle a final newline when the buffer is saved,
2095 require-final-newline, is now customizable on a per-mode basis through
2096 c-require-final-newline. That is a list of modes, and only those
2097 modes set require-final-newline. By default that's C, C++ and
2098 Objective-C.
2099
2100 The specified modes set require-final-newline based on
2101 mode-require-final-newline, as usual.
2102
2103 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2104 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
2105 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
2106 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2107 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2108
2109 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2110
2111 is now analysed as
2112
2113 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2114
2115 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2116 symbol.
2117
2118 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
2119 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
2120 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2121 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2122
2123 *** API changes for derived modes.
2124 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2125 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2126 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2127 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2128 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2129
2130 **** New language variable system.
2131 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2132
2133 **** New initialization functions.
2134 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2135 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
2136 c-init-language-vars.
2137
2138 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2139 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2140 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2141 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2142
2143 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2144 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2145 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2146 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2147 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2148
2149 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2150 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2151 its substatement. E.g:
2152
2153 if (x)
2154 x_is_true:
2155 do_stuff();
2156
2157 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2158
2159 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2160 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2161 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2162 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
2163 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
2164 inside #define's.
2165
2166 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
2167 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2168 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2169 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2170 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2171 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
2172 empty lines within the macro better.
2173
2174 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2175 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2176 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
2177
2178 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2179 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2180 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
2181 backslashes can be moved.
2182
2183 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2184 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
2185 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
2186 inserted in auto-newline mode.
2187
2188 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2189 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2190 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2191 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2192 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2193 backslash) in the macro.
2194
2195 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2196 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2197 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
2198 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2199 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
2200 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2201
2202 *** New function c-context-open-line.
2203 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
2204
2205 *** New lineup functions
2206
2207 **** c-lineup-string-cont
2208 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2209 continues. E.g:
2210
2211 result = prefix + "A message "
2212 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2213
2214 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
2215 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2216
2217 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
2218 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2219 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2220
2221 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
2222 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
2223 Ryde.
2224
2225 **** c-lineup-argcont
2226 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2227 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2228
2229 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2230 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2231 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2232 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2233 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2234 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2235
2236 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2237 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2238 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2239 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2240 context.
2241
2242 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2243 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2244 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2245 happen when macros are involved.
2246
2247 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
2248 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2249 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2250 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2251 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2252 line is left untouched.
2253
2254 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2255 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
2256 syntactic indentation.
2257
2258 +++
2259 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
2260 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
2261
2262 +++
2263 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
2264 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
2265
2266 +++
2267 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
2268 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
2269 whose names begin with space are omitted.
2270
2271 +++
2272 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
2273 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
2274 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
2275
2276 We provide two sample predicates, fill-single-word-nobreak-p and
2277 fill-french-nobreak-p, for use in the value of fill-nobreak-predicate.
2278
2279 +++
2280 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
2281 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
2282 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
2283
2284 +++
2285 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2286 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2287 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2288 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2289 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2290 from the file name or buffer contents.
2291
2292 +++
2293 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2294
2295 ---
2296 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
2297
2298 ---
2299 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2300
2301 ---
2302 ** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2303 highlighting for the old default.
2304
2305 +++
2306 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2307 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2308 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2309
2310 +++
2311 ** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2312 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2313 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2314 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2315
2316 ---
2317 ** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
2318 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2319 majority.
2320
2321 ---
2322 ** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2323 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2324
2325 ---
2326 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2327 to support use of font-lock.
2328
2329 +++
2330 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
2331 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
2332 `same-window'.
2333
2334 +++
2335 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
2336 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
2337 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
2338
2339 +++
2340 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
2341 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
2342 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
2343 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
2344 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
2345 candidate is a directory.
2346
2347 +++
2348 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
2349 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
2350 it remains unchanged.
2351
2352 ---
2353 ** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
2354
2355 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
2356 have in common and where they begin to differ.
2357
2358 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
2359 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
2360 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
2361 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
2362 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
2363 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
2364 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
2365 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
2366
2367 +++
2368 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
2369 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
2370 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
2371
2372 ---
2373 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2374
2375 +++
2376 ** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2377 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2378 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2379 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2380 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2381 used instead of the native one.
2382
2383 ---
2384 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2385 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2386 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2387
2388 ---
2389 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2390 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2391
2392 ---
2393 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2394 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2395 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2396 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2397 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2398 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2399 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
2400
2401 ---
2402 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2403 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2404 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2405 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2406 sound support for those formats.
2407
2408 ---
2409 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2410 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2411
2412 ---
2413 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2414 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2415 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2416 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2417
2418 ---
2419 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2420 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2421 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2422 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2423 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2424 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2425 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2426 you wish to use them in other faces.
2427
2428 ---
2429 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2430 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2431 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2432 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2433 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2434 any customizations.
2435
2436 +++
2437 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2438 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2439 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2440 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2441 Meta and Alt:
2442 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2443 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
2444
2445 +++
2446 ** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2447
2448 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2449 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2450 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2451
2452 P: annotates the previous revision
2453 N: annotates the next revision
2454 J: annotates the revision at line
2455 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2456 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2457 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2458 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2459
2460 +++
2461 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2462 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2463 in the repository.
2464
2465 +++
2466 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2467 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2468 "checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2469 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2470
2471 ---
2472 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2473 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2474 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2475 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2476
2477 +++
2478 ** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
2479 coding system.
2480
2481 ** On Mac OS, the value of the variable `keyboard-coding-system' is
2482 now dynamically changed according to the current keyboard script. The
2483 variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
2484 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
2485 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
2486 \f
2487 * New modes and packages in Emacs 22.1
2488
2489 +++
2490 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
2491 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
2492 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
2493 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
2494 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
2495 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
2496 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
2497 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
2498 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
2499
2500 +++
2501 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
2502 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
2503 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
2504 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
2505 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
2506 recognized.
2507
2508 +++
2509 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2510 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2511 to increment the SOA serial.
2512
2513 +++
2514 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2515 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2516
2517 ** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2518 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2519 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2520
2521 +++
2522 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
2523 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2524
2525 +++
2526 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2527 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2528
2529 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
2530 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
2531
2532 +++
2533 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2534
2535 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2536
2537 +++
2538 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2539 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2540
2541 ---
2542 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
2543
2544 ---
2545 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2546
2547 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2548 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2549 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2550 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
2551
2552 ---
2553 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2554
2555 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2556 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2557 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2558 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2559 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2560 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2561
2562 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2563 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2564 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2565 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2566
2567 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2568 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2569 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2570 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2571 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2572 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2573 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2574
2575 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2576 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2577 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2578
2579 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2580 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2581
2582 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2583 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2584 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2585 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2586
2587 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2588 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2589 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2590 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2591
2592 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2593 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2594 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2595 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2596
2597 +++
2598 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
2599 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2600 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2601 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2602 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2603
2604 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2605 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2606 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2607 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2608 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2609 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2610
2611 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2612 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2613 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2614 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2615 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2616 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2617 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
2618 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2619 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2620 or local keymaps.
2621
2622 +++
2623 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
2624 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2625
2626 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2627 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2628 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
2629 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2630
2631 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2632 defined macros.
2633
2634 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2635 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2636 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2637 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2638 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2639 for more commands.
2640
2641 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
2642 the keyboard macro ring.
2643
2644 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2645 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
2646
2647 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2648 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
2649 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
2650 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2651
2652 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
2653 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
2654 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2655
2656 ---
2657 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2658 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2659 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2660 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2661
2662 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2663
2664 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2665 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2666 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2667 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2668 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2669 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2670
2671 +++
2672 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2673
2674 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2675 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
2676 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2677 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
2678
2679 +++
2680 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
2681
2682 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2683 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2684 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2685 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2686 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2687 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2688 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2689 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2690 `rsync' to do the copying).
2691
2692 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
2693 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
2694
2695 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
2696
2697 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
2698
2699 ---
2700 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
2701 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2702 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2703 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2704 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2705 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
2706
2707 ---
2708 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
2709 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2710 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2711 settings.
2712
2713 ---
2714 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
2715 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
2716 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2717 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2718
2719 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
2720
2721 ---
2722 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
2723 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2724
2725 +++
2726 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
2727 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2728 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2729 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2730 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2731 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2732
2733 +++
2734 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2735 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2736 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2737 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2738
2739 ---
2740 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2741 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2742 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2743 mode-lines in inverse-video.
2744
2745 ---
2746 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
2747
2748 +++
2749 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2750 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2751
2752 ---
2753 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
2754
2755 ---
2756 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2757 configuration files.
2758 \f
2759 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2760
2761 +++
2762 ** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
2763 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
2764 it returns just the directory name.
2765
2766 +++
2767 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
2768 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
2769 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
2770 `undefined'.)
2771
2772 +++
2773 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
2774 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
2775 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
2776 \f
2777 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2778
2779 ** New functions, macros, and commands
2780
2781 +++
2782 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
2783 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
2784 the filtered substring. It is used instead of `buffer-substring' or
2785 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
2786 data structure, like the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register. The
2787 list of filter function is specified by the new variable
2788 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode uses
2789 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
2790 text.
2791
2792 +++
2793 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
2794 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
2795 quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
2796 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
2797
2798 +++
2799 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
2800 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
2801 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
2802
2803 +++
2804 *** New functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
2805 `progress-reporter-force-update', `progress-reporter-done', and
2806 `dotimes-with-progress-reporter' provide a simple and efficient way for
2807 a command to present progress messages for the user.
2808
2809 +++
2810 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
2811 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
2812
2813 +++
2814 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
2815 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
2816 calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
2817 only be used when you cannot add a new "interactive" argument to the
2818 command.
2819
2820 +++
2821 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
2822 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
2823 been declared obsolete.
2824
2825 ---
2826 *** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
2827 current input method to input a character.
2828
2829 +++
2830 *** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
2831 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
2832 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
2833
2834 +++
2835 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
2836 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
2837 operation.
2838
2839 +++
2840 *** The new function syntax-after returns the syntax code
2841 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
2842 of text properties as well as the character code.
2843
2844 +++
2845 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
2846 by syntax-after).
2847
2848 +++
2849 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
2850 line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
2851 number of corresponding line in current buffer.
2852
2853 +++
2854 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
2855 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
2856 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
2857 if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
2858
2859 +++
2860 *** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
2861 around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
2862 and post-command-hooks.
2863
2864 +++
2865 *** The new function `rassq-delete-all' deletes all elements from an
2866 alist whose cdr is `eq' to a specified value.
2867
2868 +++
2869 *** New macros define-obsolete-variable-alias to combine defvaralias and
2870 make-obsolete-variable and define-obsolete-function-alias to combine defalias
2871 and make-obsolete.
2872
2873 +++
2874 ** copy-file now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
2875
2876 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
2877
2878 ---
2879 ** easy-mmode-define-global-mode has been renamed to
2880 define-global-minor-mode. The old name remains as an alias.
2881
2882 +++
2883 ** An element of buffer-undo-list can now have the form (apply FUNNAME
2884 . ARGS), where FUNNAME is a symbol other than t or nil. That stands
2885 for a high-level change that should be undone by evaluating (apply
2886 FUNNAME ARGS).
2887
2888 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
2889 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
2890 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
2891
2892 +++
2893 ** The line-move, scroll-up, and scroll-down functions will now
2894 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
2895 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presense of
2896 large images. To disable this feature, Lisp code may bind the new
2897 variable `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
2898
2899 +++
2900 ** If a buffer sets buffer-save-without-query to non-nil,
2901 save-some-buffers will always save that buffer without asking
2902 (if it's modified).
2903
2904 +++
2905 ** The function symbol-file tells you which file defined
2906 a certain function or variable.
2907
2908 +++
2909 ** Lisp code can now test if a given buffer position is inside a
2910 clickable link with the new function `mouse-on-link-p'. This is the
2911 function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link' functionality.
2912
2913 +++
2914 ** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
2915 precedence over the file name. Likewise an <?xml or <!DOCTYPE declaration
2916 will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new var
2917 `magic-mode-alist'.
2918
2919 ---
2920 ** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
2921 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
2922 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
2923 several versions ago.
2924
2925 +++
2926 ** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
2927 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
2928
2929 +++
2930 ** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
2931 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
2932 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
2933 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
2934
2935 Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
2936 replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
2937
2938 ---
2939 ** list-buffers-noselect now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
2940 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
2941
2942 ---
2943 ** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
2944 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
2945
2946 +++
2947 ** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2948 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2949 previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2950
2951 +++
2952 ** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
2953 argument.
2954
2955 +++
2956 ** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
2957 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
2958
2959 +++
2960 ** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2961 `buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2962
2963 +++
2964 ** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
2965 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
2966 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
2967
2968 +++
2969 ** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
2970 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
2971 the usable window height and width is used.
2972
2973 +++
2974 ** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2975 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2976
2977 +++
2978 ** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
2979 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2980 During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2981 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2982 it changes to nil.
2983
2984 +++
2985 ** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2986
2987 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2988 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2989 example,
2990
2991 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2992
2993 +++
2994 ** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
2995 delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
2996 deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
2997 sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
2998 changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
2999
3000 +++
3001 ** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3002 undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3003 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3004
3005 +++
3006 ** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
3007 character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
3008 and ranges.
3009
3010 +++
3011 ** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
3012 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3013 arg is non-nil.
3014
3015 +++
3016 ** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3017
3018 +++
3019 ** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
3020 supported on text terminals.
3021
3022 +++
3023 ** Support for displaying image slices
3024
3025 *** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
3026 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
3027
3028 *** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
3029 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
3030
3031 *** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
3032 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
3033
3034 +++
3035 ** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
3036
3037 A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
3038 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
3039
3040 If the line-height property value is t, the newline does not
3041 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
3042 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
3043 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
3044 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
3045
3046 If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
3047 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
3048 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
3049
3050 If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
3051 is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
3052 given value.
3053
3054 If the line-height property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
3055 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
3056 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
3057
3058 If the line-height property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
3059 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
3060
3061 If the line-height value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
3062 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
3063 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
3064 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
3065 exactly that many pixels high.
3066
3067 If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
3068 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
3069 overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
3070 the line-spacing variable.
3071
3072 If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
3073 is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
3074
3075 +++
3076 ** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
3077 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
3078
3079 +++
3080 ** Enhancements to stretch display properties
3081
3082 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
3083 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
3084 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
3085
3086 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
3087 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
3088 are supported:
3089
3090 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
3091 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
3092 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
3093 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
3094 | scroll-bar | text
3095 POS ::= left | center | right
3096 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
3097 OP ::= + | -
3098
3099 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
3100 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
3101 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
3102 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
3103 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
3104 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
3105 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
3106 the image.
3107
3108 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
3109 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
3110 corresponding area of the window.
3111
3112 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
3113 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
3114 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
3115 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
3116 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
3117 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
3118 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
3119 the width of the area.
3120
3121 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
3122 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
3123
3124 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
3125 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
3126 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
3127
3128 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
3129 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
3130 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
3131 height) of the specified image.
3132
3133 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
3134 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
3135
3136 +++
3137 ** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
3138 text property string that may be present at the current window
3139 position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
3140 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
3141
3142 ** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
3143 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
3144 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and may be overridden
3145 by them).
3146
3147 +++
3148 ** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
3149 to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
3150 foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
3151 a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
3152 preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
3153 use of the capabilities of the display.
3154
3155 +++
3156 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
3157
3158 *** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
3159 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
3160
3161 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
3162 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
3163
3164 *** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
3165 previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
3166
3167 *** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
3168 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is
3169 automatically merged with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face
3170 should only specify the foreground color of the bitmap.
3171
3172 *** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
3173 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
3174 bitmap of the display line.
3175
3176 Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
3177 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
3178 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
3179 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
3180 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
3181
3182 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
3183 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
3184
3185 +++
3186 ** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
3187 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
3188 varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
3189 the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
3190
3191 Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
3192 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
3193 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
3194 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
3195 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
3196 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
3197
3198 +++
3199 ** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3200 variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
3201 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3202
3203 +++
3204 ** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
3205 the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
3206 then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3207 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3208 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3209
3210 +++
3211 ** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
3212 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
3213 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
3214
3215 +++
3216 ** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
3217 from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
3218 the first one is kept.
3219
3220 +++
3221 ** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
3222 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
3223
3224 +++
3225 ** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3226 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3227 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3228 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3229
3230 +++
3231 ** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3232 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3233 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3234 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3235
3236 +++
3237 ** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
3238 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
3239 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
3240 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
3241 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
3242
3243 +++ (lispref)
3244 ??? (man)
3245 ** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
3246 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
3247 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
3248 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
3249 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
3250
3251 +++
3252 ** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
3253 :pointer image property.
3254
3255 +++
3256 ** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
3257 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
3258
3259 +++
3260 ** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
3261
3262 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
3263 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
3264 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
3265 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
3266 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
3267 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
3268 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
3269 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
3270
3271 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
3272 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
3273 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
3274 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
3275 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
3276 for possible pointer shapes.
3277
3278 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
3279 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
3280 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
3281
3282 ** Mouse event enhancements:
3283
3284 +++
3285 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
3286 events, rather than a text area click event.
3287
3288 +++
3289 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
3290 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
3291 corresponding text row.
3292
3293 +++
3294 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
3295
3296 +++
3297 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
3298
3299 +++
3300 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
3301
3302 +++
3303 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
3304 text area).
3305
3306 +++
3307 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
3308
3309 +++
3310 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
3311
3312 +++
3313 *** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
3314
3315 +++
3316 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
3317 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
3318
3319 +++
3320 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
3321 (image or character) clicked on.
3322
3323 +++
3324 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
3325 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
3326 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
3327 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
3328
3329 +++
3330 ** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
3331 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
3332 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
3333 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
3334 forcing an explicit window update.
3335
3336 ---
3337 ** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
3338 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
3339
3340 +++
3341 ** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3342 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3343 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3344 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3345 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3346
3347 +++
3348 ** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3349
3350 +++
3351 ** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
3352 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
3353 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
3354 documented.
3355
3356 ** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
3357 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
3358 the language.
3359
3360 ---
3361 ** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
3362 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
3363 parts, e.g. utf-16.
3364
3365 +++
3366 ** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
3367 and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
3368
3369 +++
3370 ** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
3371 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
3372 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
3373
3374 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
3375 does that, this value may not be accurate.
3376
3377 +++
3378 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
3379 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
3380 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
3381 the mode line.
3382
3383 +++
3384 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
3385 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
3386
3387 +++
3388 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
3389
3390 +++
3391 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
3392 `switch-to-buffer'.
3393
3394 +++
3395 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
3396 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
3397
3398 +++
3399 ** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3400 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3401 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3402
3403 +++
3404 ** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3405 in the keymap.
3406
3407 ---
3408 ** VC changes for backends:
3409 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
3410 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
3411 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
3412 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
3413 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
3414
3415 +++
3416 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
3417 as a dynamic completion table.
3418
3419 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3420
3421 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3422 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3423 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3424 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3425 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3426 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
3427
3428 +++
3429 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
3430 as a lazy completion table.
3431
3432 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3433
3434 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3435 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3436 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3437 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3438 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3439 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3440
3441 +++
3442 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
3443
3444 +++
3445 ** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
3446 for all (existing and future) frames.
3447
3448 +++
3449 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
3450
3451 +++
3452 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
3453
3454 +++
3455 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
3456
3457 +++
3458 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
3459 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
3460 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
3461 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
3462 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
3463
3464 +++
3465 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
3466 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
3467 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
3468 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3469
3470 +++
3471 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3472 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3473 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3474 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3475
3476 ---
3477 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
3478 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
3479
3480 +++
3481 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
3482 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
3483 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
3484 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3485
3486 +++
3487 ** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
3488 of a string given to a process's filter.
3489
3490 +++
3491 ** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
3492 a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
3493
3494 +++
3495 ** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
3496 the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
3497 value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
3498 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3499
3500 +++
3501 ** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
3502 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3503 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3504 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3505 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
3506
3507 +++
3508 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3509 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3510
3511 +++
3512 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
3513 on garbage collection.
3514
3515 +++
3516 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
3517 it is read from a file without decoding.
3518
3519 +++
3520 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
3521
3522 +++
3523 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
3524 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
3525 by calling `select-window'.
3526
3527 ---
3528 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
3529 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
3530 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
3531 need to have a name.
3532
3533 ** Byte compiler changes:
3534
3535 ---
3536 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
3537 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
3538 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
3539 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
3540 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
3541 you anything.
3542
3543 +++
3544 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
3545 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
3546 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
3547 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
3548 forms:
3549
3550 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
3551 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
3552
3553 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
3554 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
3555 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
3556 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
3557 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
3558 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
3559
3560 +++
3561 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
3562 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
3563
3564 +++
3565 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3566 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3567 be inserted is translated through it.
3568
3569 +++
3570 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
3571 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
3572 current file redefined it).
3573
3574 +++
3575 ** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
3576 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
3577
3578 +++
3579 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
3580 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
3581 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
3582 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
3583 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
3584 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
3585
3586 *** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
3587 a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
3588 splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
3589 such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
3590 to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
3591
3592 *** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
3593 out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
3594 It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
3595 suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
3596 during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
3597 returns differing values.
3598
3599 +++
3600 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
3601 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
3602 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
3603
3604 +++
3605 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
3606 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
3607 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
3608 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3609
3610 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3611 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3612
3613 +++
3614 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
3615 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
3616
3617 +++
3618 ** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
3619 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3620
3621 +++
3622 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
3623 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
3624 can start with this line:
3625
3626 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
3627
3628 +++
3629 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
3630 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
3631 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
3632
3633 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
3634
3635 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
3636 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
3637
3638 +++
3639 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
3640 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
3641
3642 ---
3643 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
3644 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
3645
3646 +++
3647 ** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
3648 argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
3649 the current buffer.
3650
3651 +++
3652 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
3653 and `display-warning'.
3654
3655 +++
3656 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3657 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3658 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3659 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables may be either
3660 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3661
3662 ---
3663 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
3664 much pure storage it will approximately need.
3665
3666 +++
3667 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
3668 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
3669 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
3670 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
3671
3672 ---
3673 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
3674 of one coding system from another coding system.
3675
3676 +++
3677 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3678 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3679 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3680 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3681 needed.
3682
3683 ---
3684 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3685 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3686 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3687 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3688 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3689 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3690
3691 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3692 confirmation as before.
3693
3694 +++
3695 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
3696
3697 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3698 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3699 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3700 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
3701
3702 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3703 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3704 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3705 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3706 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3707 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
3708
3709 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3710 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3711 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3712 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3713
3714 +++
3715 ** Per-window fringes settings
3716
3717 Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
3718 settings.
3719
3720 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3721 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3722 `set-window-fringes'.
3723
3724 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3725 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3726 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3727 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3728
3729 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3730 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3731 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3732 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3733 an update of the display margins.
3734
3735 +++
3736 ** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
3737
3738 Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3739 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3740
3741 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3742 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3743 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3744 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3745 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3746 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3747 of the display margins.
3748
3749 +++
3750 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3751 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3752 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3753
3754 +++
3755 ** Renamed hooks to better follow the naming convention:
3756 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
3757 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
3758 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
3759 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
3760 x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
3761 x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions.
3762 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
3763
3764 +++
3765 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
3766 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
3767 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
3768
3769 +++
3770 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3771 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3772 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3773 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3774 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3775
3776 ---
3777 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3778 to override the internal read-file-name function.
3779
3780 +++
3781 ** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3782 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3783 `read-file-name' function.
3784
3785 +++
3786 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3787 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3788 will only show directories.
3789
3790 +++
3791 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3792 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3793 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3794 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3795
3796 ---
3797 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
3798 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
3799 (require 'cl) when loaded.
3800
3801 +++
3802 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3803 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3804 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3805
3806 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3807
3808 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3809 declaration specifiers supported are:
3810
3811 (indent INDENT)
3812 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3813
3814 (edebug DEBUG)
3815 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3816 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3817
3818 +++
3819 ** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3820
3821 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
3822 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3823 binding and lookup functionality.
3824
3825 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3826 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3827 original command.
3828
3829 Example:
3830 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3831 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3832 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3833 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3834 kill-word.
3835
3836 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3837 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3838 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3839 map using define-key:
3840
3841 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3842 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3843
3844 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3845 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3846
3847 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3848 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3849 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3850
3851 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3852
3853 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3854 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3855 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3856 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3857
3858 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3859 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3860
3861 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3862 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3863
3864 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3865 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3866 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3867 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3868 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3869 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3870
3871 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3872 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3873 command was not remapped.
3874
3875 +++
3876 ** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3877
3878 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3879 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3880 alist to this list.
3881
3882 +++
3883 ** Atomic change groups.
3884
3885 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3886 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3887 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3888
3889 (atomic-change-group
3890 (insert foo)
3891 (delete-region x y))
3892
3893 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3894 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3895 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3896 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3897
3898 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3899 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3900
3901 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3902 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3903 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3904 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3905
3906 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3907 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3908 do this.
3909
3910 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3911 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3912 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3913 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3914
3915 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3916 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3917 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3918 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3919 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3920 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3921 twice.
3922
3923 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3924 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3925 returned values, like this:
3926
3927 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3928 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3929
3930 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3931 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3932 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3933
3934 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3935 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3936 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3937 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3938 finished.
3939
3940 +++
3941 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3942
3943 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3944 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3945 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3946 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3947
3948 +++
3949 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3950
3951 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3952 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3953 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3954 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3955
3956 +++
3957 ** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
3958
3959 The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
3960 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
3961 a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
3962
3963 +++
3964 ** New function insert-for-yank.
3965
3966 This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
3967 properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
3968 inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
3969 character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
3970 a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
3971
3972 +++
3973 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
3974
3975 This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
3976 text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
3977
3978 +++
3979 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
3980
3981 This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
3982 text properties from the inserted substring.
3983
3984 +++
3985 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3986 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3987
3988 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
3989 elements with the following format:
3990 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3991
3992 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3993 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3994 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3995 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3996
3997 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3998 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3999 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
4000 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
4001 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
4002 rectangle.
4003 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
4004 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
4005 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
4006 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
4007 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
4008 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
4009 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
4010 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
4011
4012 +++
4013 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
4014 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
4015 the killed text.
4016
4017 +++
4018 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
4019 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
4020 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
4021 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
4022 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
4023
4024 +++
4025 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
4026 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4027
4028 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4029 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4030 defined with defface.
4031
4032 ---
4033 ** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
4034 given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
4035 it did only a very cursory check).
4036
4037 +++
4038 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
4039 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
4040 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
4041
4042 +++
4043 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
4044 help with handling relative face attributes.
4045
4046 +++
4047 ** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
4048 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4049 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
4050 of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
4051 :inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
4052 properties.
4053
4054 +++
4055 ** Enhancements to process support
4056
4057 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4058 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
4059
4060 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
4061 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
4062 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
4063
4064 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
4065 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
4066
4067 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4068 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4069
4070 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
4071 and modify elements on this property list.
4072
4073 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
4074 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
4075
4076 *** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
4077 `just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4078 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4079 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4080 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4081 speech synthesis.
4082
4083 ---
4084 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4085
4086 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4087 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4088 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4089 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
4090 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4091 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4092 emacs tries to read it.
4093
4094 +++
4095 ** Enhanced networking support.
4096
4097 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
4098 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4099 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4100
4101 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4102 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4103 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4104 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4105 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4106 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4107 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4108 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4109
4110 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4111 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4112
4113 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
4114
4115 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
4116
4117 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
4118 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
4119 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
4120 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
4121 matching "open" or "failed".
4122
4123 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
4124
4125 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
4126 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
4127 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
4128 is called for the new process.
4129
4130 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
4131
4132 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4133 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4134
4135 *** New function format-network-address.
4136
4137 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
4138 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4139 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4140 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4141 string for other formatting options.
4142
4143 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
4144 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
4145 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
4146
4147 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
4148 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
4149 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
4150 the fifth is the port number.
4151
4152 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
4153 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
4154 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
4155 no input is received in the stopped state.
4156
4157 *** New function network-interface-list.
4158
4159 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4160 current network addresses.
4161
4162 *** New function network-interface-info.
4163
4164 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4165 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4166
4167 +++
4168 ** New function copy-tree.
4169
4170 +++
4171 ** New function substring-no-properties.
4172
4173 +++
4174 ** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
4175
4176 +++
4177 ** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
4178
4179 +++
4180 ** New function `process-file'.
4181
4182 This is similar to `call-process', but obeys file handlers. The file
4183 handler is chosen based on default-directory.
4184
4185 ---
4186 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
4187 are now always lower case. If you specify the
4188 menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4189 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4190
4191 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
4192 the bindings that were made with easymenu.
4193
4194 +++
4195 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
4196 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
4197 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
4198 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
4199
4200 ---
4201 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4202 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4203
4204 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4205 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4206 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4207 commands.
4208
4209 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4210 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4211 SQL buffer.
4212
4213 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4214 (function (lambda ()
4215 (master-mode t)
4216 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4217 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4218 (function (lambda ()
4219 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4220
4221 +++
4222 ** File local variables.
4223
4224 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
4225 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
4226
4227 +++
4228 ** New function window-body-height.
4229
4230 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
4231 or the header line.
4232
4233 +++
4234 ** New function format-mode-line.
4235
4236 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
4237 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4238
4239 +++
4240 ** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer signals an error for
4241 a malformed property list. They also detect cyclic lists.
4242
4243 +++
4244 ** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
4245
4246 These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
4247 compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
4248
4249 +++
4250 ** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
4251
4252 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
4253 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
4254 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
4255 you specify the map to use as an argument.
4256
4257 +++
4258 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
4259
4260 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
4261 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
4262 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
4263
4264 +++
4265 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4266
4267 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4268 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4269 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4270 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4271 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4272
4273 +++
4274 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4275 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4276 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4277 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4278
4279 +++
4280 ** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4281 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4282
4283 +++
4284 ** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4285 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4286 line.
4287
4288 ---
4289 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
4290 cl-indent package. The new user options
4291 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
4292 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
4293 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
4294
4295 ---
4296 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
4297 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
4298
4299 +++
4300 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4301
4302 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4303 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4304 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4305 now:
4306
4307 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4308
4309 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4310 the time it takes to convert the format.
4311
4312 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4313 wasteful.
4314
4315 +++
4316 ** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4317 over minor mode keymaps.
4318
4319 +++
4320 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
4321 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
4322
4323 +++
4324 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
4325 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
4326 image or composition property.
4327
4328 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4329 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4330 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4331 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4332 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4333
4334 +++
4335 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
4336 argument, LIMIT.
4337
4338 +++
4339 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
4340 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
4341 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
4342 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
4343 flag.
4344
4345 ---
4346 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
4347
4348 ---
4349 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
4350
4351 ---
4352 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
4353 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
4354 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
4355 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
4356 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
4357 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4358
4359 ---
4360 ** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4361 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4362 bindings of the parent keymap.
4363
4364 ---
4365 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4366 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4367 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
4368 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4369 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
4370 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4371
4372 s{
4373 foo
4374 }{
4375 bar
4376 }e
4377
4378 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4379 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
4380 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4381 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4382
4383 ---
4384 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
4385 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
4386
4387 +++
4388 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
4389 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
4390
4391 +++
4392 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
4393 it receives a request from emacsclient.
4394
4395 ---
4396 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4397 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4398 than 3 levels of nesting.
4399
4400 ---
4401 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4402 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4403 it in that buffer.
4404
4405 ---
4406 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
4407 properties from surrounding text.
4408
4409 +++
4410 ** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
4411 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
4412 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
4413
4414 +++
4415 ** New function `buffer-local-value'.
4416
4417 This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
4418 in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
4419 buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
4420
4421 ---
4422 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
4423 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
4424 clone to the other.
4425
4426 +++
4427 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4428 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
4429 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
4430 other properties than `face'.
4431 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
4432 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4433
4434 ---
4435 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4436 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4437 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4438 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4439 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4440
4441 +++
4442 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4443 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
4444 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4445
4446 +++
4447 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4448 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
4449
4450 +++
4451 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4452 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4453
4454 +++
4455 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4456 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4457 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4458
4459 +++
4460 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4461 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4462 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4463
4464 +++
4465 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4466 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4467 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4468
4469 ---
4470 ** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4471
4472 +++
4473 ** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
4474
4475 +++
4476 ** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
4477 character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
4478 of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
4479 the output of other GNU tools.
4480
4481 +++
4482 ** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
4483
4484 ---
4485 ** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
4486
4487 +++
4488 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4489 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
4490
4491 +++
4492 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
4493
4494 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
4495
4496 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
4497 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
4498 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
4499 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
4500
4501 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
4502 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
4503
4504 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
4505
4506 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
4507 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
4508 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
4509
4510 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
4511 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
4512
4513 +++
4514 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
4515 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4516
4517 +++
4518 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
4519 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
4520
4521 +++
4522 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
4523 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
4524
4525 ---
4526 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4527 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4528 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4529
4530 ---
4531 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
4532 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4533 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4534
4535 ---
4536 ** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
4537 running under X.
4538
4539 +++
4540 ** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can remove
4541 all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
4542
4543 ** New packages:
4544
4545 +++
4546 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
4547 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
4548 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
4549 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
4550 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
4551 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
4552
4553 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
4554
4555 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
4556 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
4557
4558 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4559 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4560 data structures.
4561
4562 ---
4563 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
4564 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
4565
4566 +++
4567 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
4568 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
4569 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
4570 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
4571 as help and apropos buffers.
4572
4573 \f
4574 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4575
4576 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4577 been added.
4578
4579 \f
4580 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
4581
4582 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4583 with Custom.
4584
4585 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
4586 as mule-utf-8.
4587
4588 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4589 in UTF-8 locales).
4590
4591 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4592 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4593 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4594 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4595 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4596 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4597 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4598 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4599 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4600 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4601
4602 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4603 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4604
4605 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4606 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4607 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4608 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
4609 contrary to the compound text specification.
4610
4611 \f
4612 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4613
4614 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4615
4616 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4617
4618 \f
4619 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
4620
4621 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4622
4623 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4624 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4625 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4626 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4627 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4628
4629 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4630 were changed.
4631
4632 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4633 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4634
4635 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4636 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4637 instead of using default-major-mode.
4638
4639 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4640 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4641 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4642 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4643 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4644 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4645 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4646
4647 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4648 NEWS.
4649
4650 \f
4651 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4652
4653 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4654 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4655 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4656
4657 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4658 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4659
4660 \f
4661 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4662
4663 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4664 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4665 charsets in this release.
4666
4667 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4668
4669 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4670
4671 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
4672 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4673 to list them.
4674
4675 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
4676 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
4677 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4678 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4679 necessary changes to unexec.
4680
4681 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4682 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4683
4684 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4685 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4686
4687 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4688 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
4689
4690 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
4691 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
4692 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4693 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4694 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
4695
4696 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4697 new display features described below.
4698
4699 \f
4700 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
4701
4702 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4703
4704 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4705 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4706 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4707 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4708 the text.
4709
4710 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4711
4712 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4713 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4714 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4715 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4716 specify a font.
4717
4718 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4719 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4720 under Lisp changes, below.
4721
4722 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4723
4724 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4725 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4726 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4727 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4728 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4729 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4730 on terminals.
4731
4732 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4733 supported on character terminals.
4734
4735 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4736 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4737 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4738 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4739
4740 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4741
4742 ** Sound support
4743
4744 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4745 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4746 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
4747 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4748 sound support.
4749
4750 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4751
4752 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4753 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4754 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4755 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4756
4757 - User option: max-mini-window-height
4758
4759 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4760 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4761 specifies a number of lines.
4762
4763 Default is 0.25.
4764
4765 - User option: resize-mini-windows
4766
4767 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4768 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4769 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4770 again.
4771
4772 Default is `grow-only'.
4773
4774 ** LessTif support.
4775
4776 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
4777 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
4778
4779 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4780
4781 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4782 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4783 non-nil.
4784
4785 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4786
4787 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4788 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4789 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4790
4791 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
4792
4793 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4794 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4795 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4796 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4797 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4798 Emacs.
4799
4800 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4801 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4802 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4803 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4804 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4805 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4806
4807 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4808 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4809 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4810 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4811 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4812 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4813
4814 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4815 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4816 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
4817 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
4818 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4819
4820 ** Tool bar support.
4821
4822 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4823 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4824 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4825 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4826 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4827 icons will be used.
4828
4829 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
4830 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
4831
4832 ** Tooltips.
4833
4834 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4835 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4836 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4837
4838 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4839 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4840 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4841 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4842
4843 ** Automatic Hscrolling
4844
4845 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4846 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4847 customized.
4848
4849 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4850 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4851 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4852 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4853 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4854
4855 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4856 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4857 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
4858 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
4859 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
4860 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
4861
4862 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4863 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4864 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4865 customizing face `fringe'.
4866
4867 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4868 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4869 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4870 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4871 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4872 the window to be partially obscured.)
4873
4874 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
4875 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4876 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4877 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
4878
4879 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4880
4881 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4882 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4883 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4884 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4885 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4886 have enabled one.
4887
4888 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4889
4890 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
4891
4892 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
4893
4894 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4895 `*') toggles the status.
4896
4897 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4898
4899 ** Hourglass pointer
4900
4901 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4902 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4903
4904 ** Blinking cursor
4905
4906 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4907 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4908 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4909 the group `cursor'.
4910
4911 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4912
4913 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4914 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4915 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4916 details.
4917
4918 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4919 have to do anything to activate it.
4920
4921 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4922
4923 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4924 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4925
4926 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4927 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4928 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4929 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4930 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4931 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4932 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4933 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4934
4935 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4936 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4937 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4938 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4939 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4940 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4941
4942 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4943 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4944
4945 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4946 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4947 buffer by default.
4948
4949 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4950 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4951 beginning and end of the buffer.
4952
4953 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4954 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4955 signaled.
4956
4957 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4958 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4959
4960 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4961 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4962 this behavior.
4963
4964 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
4965 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4966 Emacs dump core.
4967
4968 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4969
4970 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4971 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4972 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4973
4974 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4975 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4976 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4977
4978 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4979 using that menu.
4980
4981 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4982
4983 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4984 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4985 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4986 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4987 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4988 whitespace.
4989
4990 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4991 all frames except the selected one.
4992
4993 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
4994 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
4995
4996 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
4997 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
4998 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
4999 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5000 `Info-use-header-line'.
5001
5002 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5003 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5004 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5005
5006 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5007
5008 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5009 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5010 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5011
5012 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5013 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5014 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5015 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5016
5017 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5018
5019 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5020 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5021 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5022 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5023
5024 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5025 point in a pop-up window.
5026
5027 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5028 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5029 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5030
5031 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5032 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5033
5034 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5035 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5036 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5037 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5038
5039 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5040
5041 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5042 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5043
5044 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5045 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5046 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5047
5048 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5049 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5050 non-nil.
5051
5052 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5053 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5054 file that is already visited under a different name.
5055
5056 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5057 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5058
5059 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5060 and displays information about that.
5061
5062 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5063 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5064
5065 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5066 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5067 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5068 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5069 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5070 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5071
5072 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5073 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5074
5075 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5076 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5077 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5078 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5079 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5080 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5081 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5082
5083 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5084 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5085
5086 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5087 system for keyboard input.
5088
5089 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5090 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5091 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5092 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5093 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5094 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5095 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5096 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5097 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5098
5099 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5100 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5101
5102 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5103 displays all characters in that character set.
5104
5105 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5106 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5107
5108 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5109 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5110 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5111
5112 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5113 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5114 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5115 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5116 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5117 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5118 and Polish `slash'.
5119
5120 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5121 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5122 of the tutorial.
5123
5124 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5125 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5126 Lisp Coding Convention".
5127
5128 new command old-binding
5129 --- ------- -----------
5130 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5131 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5132 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5133
5134 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5135 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5136 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5137
5138 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5139 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5140 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5141 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5142 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5143 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5144
5145 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5146 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5147 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5148 package.
5149
5150 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5151 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5152 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5153 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5154 "`", you must type "=q".
5155
5156 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5157 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5158 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5159 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5160 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5161 on.
5162
5163 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5164 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5165 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5166 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5167
5168 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5169 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5170 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5171 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5172
5173 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5174 on the display using several methods
5175
5176 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5177 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5178 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5179
5180 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5181 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5182
5183 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5184
5185 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5186 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5187
5188 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5189 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5190 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5191 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5192
5193 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5194 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5195 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5196
5197 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5198 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5199
5200 ** New X resources recognized
5201
5202 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5203 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5204 is useful for debugging X problems.
5205
5206 Example:
5207
5208 emacs.synchronous: true
5209
5210 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5211 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5212 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5213 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5214 visual class names are
5215
5216 TrueColor
5217 PseudoColor
5218 DirectColor
5219 StaticColor
5220 GrayScale
5221 StaticGray
5222
5223 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5224 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5225 meaning.
5226
5227 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5228 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5229 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5230 visual.
5231
5232 Example:
5233
5234 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5235
5236 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5237 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5238 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5239 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5240
5241 Example:
5242
5243 emacs.privateColormap: true
5244
5245 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5246
5247 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5248 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5249 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5250 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5251 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5252 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5253 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5254
5255 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5256 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5257 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5258 `default' face and vice versa.
5259
5260 ** New face `menu'.
5261
5262 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5263
5264 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5265
5266 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5267 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5268 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5269 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5270
5271 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5272 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5273 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5274
5275 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5276 `ScreenGamma'.
5277
5278 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5279
5280 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5281 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5282 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5283 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5284
5285 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5286
5287 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5288
5289 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5290
5291 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5292 LessTif/Motif one.
5293
5294 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5295 LessTif and Motif.
5296
5297 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5298
5299 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5300 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5301 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5302
5303 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5304 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5305
5306 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5307 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5308 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5309
5310 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5311
5312 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5313 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5314 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5315 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5316
5317 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5318 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5319 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5320 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5321
5322 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5323 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5324 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5325 buffers.
5326
5327 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5328
5329 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5330 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5331 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5332
5333 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5334 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5335 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5336 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5337 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5338 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5339
5340 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5341
5342 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5343 notably at the end of lines.
5344
5345 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5346 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5347
5348 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5349
5350 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5351 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5352
5353 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5354 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5355 after each match to get the replacement text.
5356
5357 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5358 you edit the replacement string.
5359
5360 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5361 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5362 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5363
5364 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5365
5366 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5367 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5368
5369 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5370 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5371 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5372 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5373
5374 --
5375 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5376 read mail from the menu etc.
5377
5378 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5379 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5380 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5381 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5382
5383 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5384 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5385
5386 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5387 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5388 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5389 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5390 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5391 of Emacs.
5392
5393 ** Customize changes
5394
5395 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5396 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5397 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5398 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5399 earlier versions of Emacs.
5400
5401 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5402 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5403 default).
5404
5405 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5406 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5407 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5408 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5409 file.
5410
5411 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5412 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5413 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5414 already in your init file.
5415
5416 ** New features in evaluation commands
5417
5418 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5419 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5420 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5421 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5422 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5423
5424 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5425 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5426 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5427 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5428 printed).
5429
5430 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5431 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5432
5433 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5434 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5435
5436 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5437 code when called with a prefix argument.
5438
5439 ** CC mode changes.
5440
5441 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5442 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5443 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5444 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5445 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5446 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5447 release.
5448
5449 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5450 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5451 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5452 confusion.
5453
5454 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5455 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5456 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5457 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5458
5459 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5460 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5461
5462 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5463 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5464
5465 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5466 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5467 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5468 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5469
5470 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5471 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5472 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5473 earlier statement. An example:
5474
5475 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5476 if (a[i])
5477 res += a[i]->offset;
5478 else
5479
5480 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5481 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5482 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5483 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5484 the preceding "if".
5485
5486 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5487 by default.
5488
5489 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5490 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5491 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5492 documentation or other natural language text.
5493
5494 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5495 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5496 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5497 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5498 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5499 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5500 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5501
5502 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5503 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5504 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5505 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5506
5507 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5508 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5509 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5510 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5511 Pike mode only.
5512
5513 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5514 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5515 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5516 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5517 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5518 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5519 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5520 is reported afterwards.
5521
5522 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5523 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5524 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5525
5526 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5527 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5528 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5529 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5530 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5531 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5532 groundwork.
5533
5534 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5535 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5536 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5537 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5538 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5539 have to bother.
5540
5541 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5542 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
5543 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
5544 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5545 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5546 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5547
5548 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5549 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5550 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5551 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5552 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5553 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5554 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5555 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5556
5557 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5558 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5559 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5560 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5561 above.
5562
5563 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5564 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5565 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5566 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5567 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5568 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5569 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5570 function documentation for more info.
5571
5572 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5573 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5574 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5575 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5576 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5577 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5578 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5579 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5580
5581 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5582
5583 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5584 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5585
5586 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5587 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5588 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5589 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5590 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5591 style system.
5592
5593 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5594 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5595 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5596 as far as possible.
5597
5598 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5599 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5600 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5601 chapter about this in the manual.
5602
5603 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5604 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5605 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5606 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5607 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5608
5609 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5610 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5611 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5612
5613 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5614 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5615
5616 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5617 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5618 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5619 inside CC Mode.
5620
5621 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5622 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5623 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5624 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5625 cc-mode/).
5626
5627 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5628 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5629 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5630 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5631 they were before the filling.
5632
5633 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5634 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5635 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5636 literals.
5637
5638 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5639 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5640 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5641 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5642 this function.
5643
5644 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
5645 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5646 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5647 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5648 Thanks to Eric Eide.
5649
5650 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5651 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5652 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5653
5654 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5655
5656 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5657 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5658 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5659 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5660
5661 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5662 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5663 the column specified by comment-column.
5664
5665 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5666 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5667 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5668 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5669 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5670 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5671
5672 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5673 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5674 arguments.
5675
5676 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5677
5678 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5679 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5680 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5681 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5682 Provan).
5683
5684 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5685
5686 ** Dired changes
5687
5688 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5689 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5690 is, delete only empty directories.
5691
5692 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5693 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5694 copy directories recursively.
5695
5696 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5697 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5698 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
5699
5700 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5701 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5702 directory.
5703
5704 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
5705 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5706 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5707 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5708 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5709
5710 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5711 from ls switches.
5712
5713 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5714 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5715 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5716 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
5717
5718 ** Gnus changes.
5719
5720 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5721 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5722 internationalization and mail-fetching.
5723
5724 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5725 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
5726
5727 If you used procmail like in
5728
5729 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5730 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5731 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5732 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
5733
5734 this now has changed to
5735
5736 (setq mail-sources
5737 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5738 :suffix ".in")))
5739
5740 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5741 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
5742
5743 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5744 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5745 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5746 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
5747
5748 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5749 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5750 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
5751
5752 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5753 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5754 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5755 now just a compatibility layer.
5756
5757 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5758 Gnus facilities.
5759
5760 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5761 called to position point.
5762
5763 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5764 summary buffers and NOV files.
5765
5766 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5767 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
5768
5769 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5770 subtly different manner.
5771
5772 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5773 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5774 ever-changing layouts.
5775
5776 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
5777
5778 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
5779
5780 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
5781
5782 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5783 macros
5784
5785 Key binding Macro
5786 -------------------------
5787 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5788 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5789 C-c C-c u @uref
5790 C-c C-c q @quotation
5791 C-c C-c m @email
5792 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5793 M-RET @item
5794
5795 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
5796
5797 ** Changes in Outline mode.
5798
5799 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5800 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5801 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
5802
5803 ** Changes to Emacs Server
5804
5805 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5806 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5807 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5808 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5809 buffers to kill, as before.
5810
5811 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5812 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5813 this way.
5814
5815 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5816 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5817
5818 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5819
5820 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5821 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5822 use. Default is 1000.
5823
5824 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5825 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
5826
5827 ** Changes to hideshow.el
5828
5829 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
5830
5831 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5832 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5833 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5834 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
5835
5836 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5837 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5838 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5839 the open block.
5840
5841 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5842 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5843 the normal block-hiding function.
5844
5845 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
5846
5847 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5848 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5849 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5850 for `hs-minor-mode'.
5851
5852 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5853 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
5854
5855 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
5856
5857 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5858 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5859 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
5860
5861 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5862 current buffer.
5863
5864 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5865 in a log file.
5866
5867 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5868 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5869 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5870 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5871 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5872 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5873
5874 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5875
5876 ** Changes to cmuscheme
5877
5878 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5879 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5880
5881 ** Changes in Font Lock
5882
5883 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5884 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5885
5886 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5887 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5888
5889 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5890 the face used for each string/comment.
5891
5892 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5893 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5894
5895 ** Changes to Shell mode
5896
5897 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5898 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5899 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5900 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5901
5902 ** Comint (subshell) changes
5903
5904 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5905 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5906
5907 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5908 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5909 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5910 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5911 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5912 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5913
5914 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5915 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5916 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5917 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5918 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5919 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5920 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5921 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5922
5923 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5924 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5925
5926 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5927 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5928 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5929
5930 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5931 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5932 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5933
5934 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5935 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5936 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5937
5938 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5939 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5940 argument, it appends to the file.
5941
5942 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5943 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5944 compatibility.
5945
5946 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5947 ring (history).
5948
5949 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5950 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5951 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5952
5953 ** Changes to Rmail mode
5954
5955 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5956 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5957 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5958 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5959 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5960 as correspondent.
5961
5962 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5963 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5964 regexp matching your mail addresses.
5965
5966 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5967 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5968 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5969 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5970 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5971
5972 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5973 like `j'.
5974
5975 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5976 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5977 digest message.
5978
5979 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5980 in which folder to put messages automatically.
5981
5982 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5983 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5984 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5985
5986 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5987 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5988
5989 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5990 use the -f option when sending mail.
5991
5992 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
5993 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
5994 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
5995 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
5996 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
5997 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
5998
5999 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6000 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6001 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6002
6003 ** Changes to TeX mode
6004
6005 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6006 `latex-mode'.
6007
6008 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6009
6010 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6011
6012 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6013
6014 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6015
6016 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6017 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6018 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6019 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6020 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6021 can be edited from that buffer.
6022
6023 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6024 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6025 `A' to use all marked entries).
6026
6027 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6028 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6029
6030 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6031 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6032 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6033 been cited.
6034
6035 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6036 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6037 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6038 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6039
6040 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6041 has the following new features:
6042
6043 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6044 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6045 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6046 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6047
6048 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6049 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6050 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6051 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6052 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6053 defaults to 1.
6054
6055 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6056 file names.
6057
6058 ** Ispell changes
6059
6060 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6061 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6062 spell-checks the current buffer.
6063
6064 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6065 added.
6066
6067 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6068 correction is made and re-checked.
6069
6070 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6071
6072 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6073 cases.
6074
6075 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6076 on syntax errors.
6077
6078 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6079 end of the buffer.
6080
6081 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6082
6083 ** Makefile mode changes
6084
6085 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6086
6087 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6088 Fontlock mode is active.
6089
6090 ** Isearch changes
6091
6092 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6093 so that searches can be resumed.
6094
6095 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6096 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6097 that started the search.
6098
6099 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6100 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6101
6102 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6103
6104 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6105 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6106 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6107 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6108 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6109 `secondary-selection'.
6110
6111 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6112 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6113 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6114 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6115 usual snappy response.
6116
6117 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6118 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6119 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6120 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6121
6122 ** VC Changes
6123
6124 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6125 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6126 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6127 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6128 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6129 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6130 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6131 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6132 file is registered in that backend.
6133
6134 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6135 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6136 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6137 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6138 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6139 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6140
6141 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6142 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6143 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6144 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6145 where it doesn't make sense.)
6146
6147 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6148 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6149 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6150
6151 *** General Changes
6152
6153 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6154 checks are always done now.
6155
6156 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6157 operations.
6158
6159 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6160 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6161 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6162
6163 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6164 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6165 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6166 the working file (``merge news'').
6167
6168 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6169 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6170 downwards.
6171
6172 *** Multiple Backends
6173
6174 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6175 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6176 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6177 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6178 local RCS archives.
6179
6180 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6181 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6182 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6183 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6184
6185 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6186 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6187 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6188 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6189 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6190
6191 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6192 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6193 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6194 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6195
6196 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6197 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6198 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6199 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6200
6201 *** Changes for CVS
6202
6203 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6204 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6205 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6206 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6207 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6208 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6209 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6210
6211 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6212 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6213 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6214 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6215 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6216 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6217 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6218 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6219 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6220 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6221 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6222 name.)
6223
6224 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6225 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6226 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6227 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6228 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6229 entire directory tree.
6230
6231 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6232 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6233 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6234 "watched" by other developers.)
6235
6236 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6237 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6238 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6239 starting at the given directory.
6240
6241 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6242
6243 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6244 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6245 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6246 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6247 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6248 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6249 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6250 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6251 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6252
6253 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6254 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6255 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6256 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6257
6258 ** New modes and packages
6259
6260 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6261 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6262 the default is not applicable.
6263
6264 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6265 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6266 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6267
6268 Features are:
6269
6270 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6271 drawn, like this: | \ /
6272 --+-- X
6273 | / \
6274
6275 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6276 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6277 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6278 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6279 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6280 you are drawing.
6281
6282 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6283 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6284
6285 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6286 flood-filling.
6287
6288 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6289 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6290 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6291 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6292
6293 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6294 also do without the mouse.
6295
6296 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6297 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6298 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6299 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6300 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6301
6302 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6303
6304 lines straight-lines
6305 rectangles squares
6306 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6307 ellipses circles
6308 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6309 spray-can setting size for spraying
6310 vaporize line vaporize lines
6311 erase characters erase rectangles
6312
6313 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6314 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6315 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6316 drawing.
6317
6318 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6319 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6320 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6321 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6322
6323 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6324 can be turned off).
6325
6326 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6327 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6328 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6329 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6330 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6331 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6332 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6333 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6334 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6335
6336 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6337 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6338 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6339 on certain projects.
6340
6341 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6342 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6343
6344 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6345
6346 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6347 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6348 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6349 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6350 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6351 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6352 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6353 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6354
6355 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6356 Emacs is idle.
6357
6358 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6359 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6360
6361 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6362 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6363
6364 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6365 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6366 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6367 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6368 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6369
6370 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6371 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6372 separate Texinfo file.
6373
6374 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6375 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6376 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6377 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6378 enter check-in log messages.
6379
6380 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6381 without invoking external programs.
6382
6383 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6384 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6385 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6386 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6387 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6388
6389 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6390 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6391
6392 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6393 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6394
6395 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6396 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6397 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6398 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6399 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6400 single step.
6401
6402 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6403 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6404 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6405 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6406
6407 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6408 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6409 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6410
6411 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6412 PostScript.
6413
6414 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6415
6416 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6417
6418 ; comment (until end of line)
6419 A non-terminal
6420 "C" terminal
6421 ?C? special
6422 $A default non-terminal
6423 $"C" default terminal
6424 $?C? default special
6425 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6426 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6427 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6428 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6429 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6430 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6431 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6432 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6433 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6434 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6435 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6436 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6437 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6438 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6439 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6440
6441 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6442
6443 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6444 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6445 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6446 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6447 equal signs of assignments.
6448
6449 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6450 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6451
6452 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6453 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6454 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6455
6456 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6457
6458 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6459 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6460 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6461 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6462 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6463 which answers different needs.
6464
6465 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6466 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6467 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6468 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6469 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6470 to be enabled.
6471
6472 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6473 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6474
6475 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6476
6477 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6478 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6479 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6480
6481 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6482
6483 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6484 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6485 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6486 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6487 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6488 and background colors.
6489
6490 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6491 Pascal) language.
6492
6493 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6494 the text at point.
6495
6496 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6497
6498 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6499
6500 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6501 whitespace in a file.
6502
6503 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6504 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6505 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6506 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6507 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6508 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6509 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6510
6511 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6512
6513 Here is an example of columns:
6514
6515 horse apple bus
6516 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6517 porcupine strawberry airplane
6518
6519 Doing the following settings:
6520
6521 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6522 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6523 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6524 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6525
6526
6527 Selecting the lines above and typing:
6528
6529 M-x delimit-columns-region
6530
6531 It results:
6532
6533 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
6534 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6535 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6536
6537 delim-col has the following options:
6538
6539 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6540 before all columns.
6541
6542 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6543 between each column.
6544
6545 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6546 after all columns.
6547
6548 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6549 each column.
6550
6551 delim-col has the following commands:
6552
6553 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6554 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6555
6556 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6557 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6558 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6559 recent file list can be displayed:
6560
6561 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
6562 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6563 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
6564
6565 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6566 dynamically change the menu appearance.
6567
6568 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6569 text.
6570
6571 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
6572 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6573 specific to Message mode.
6574
6575 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6576 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6577 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6578
6579 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6580 interface to access directory servers using different directory
6581 protocols. It has a separate manual.
6582
6583 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6584 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6585
6586 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6587
6588 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
6589 minibuffer with completion.
6590
6591 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6592 with the diary features.
6593
6594 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6595 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6596
6597 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6598 Fill mode.
6599
6600 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6601 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6602 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6603 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
6604
6605 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6606 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6607 `.g'.
6608
6609 ** Changes in sort.el
6610
6611 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6612 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6613 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6614 numeric base.
6615
6616 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
6617
6618 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6619 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6620 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6621
6622 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6623 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6624
6625 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6626 output ^M at the end of lines.
6627
6628 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6629 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6630
6631 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6632 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6633 `(msb-mode 1)'.
6634
6635 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6636 group.
6637
6638 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6639 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6640 are recognized:
6641
6642 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6643 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6644 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6645 nil -- just delete one character.
6646
6647 Default value is `untabify'.
6648
6649 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6650
6651 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6652 symbol, not double-quoted.
6653
6654 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6655 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6656 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6657 moved to lisp/obsolete.
6658
6659 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6660 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6661 `auto-compression-mode' command.
6662
6663 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6664 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6665 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6666
6667 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6668 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6669
6670 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6671 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6672
6673 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6674 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6675
6676 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6677 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6678 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6679 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6680 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6681 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6682
6683 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6684 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6685
6686 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6687
6688 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6689 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6690
6691 ** Shell script mode changes.
6692
6693 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6694 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6695 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6696
6697 ** Etags changes.
6698
6699 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6700
6701 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6702 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6703 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6704 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6705 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6706
6707 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6708 declarations when given the --declarations option.
6709
6710 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6711 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6712
6713 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6714 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6715 `template' keywords.
6716
6717 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6718 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6719
6720 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6721 types.
6722
6723 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6724
6725 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6726
6727 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6728 are now tagged.
6729
6730 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6731
6732 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6733 variables are tagged.
6734
6735 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6736
6737 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6738 for PSWrap.
6739
6740 ** Changes in etags.el
6741
6742 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6743 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6744 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6745
6746 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6747 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6748
6749 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6750 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6751 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6752 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6753
6754 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6755
6756 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6757 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6758
6759 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6760
6761 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6762 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6763 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6764
6765 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6766 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6767
6768 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6769 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6770
6771 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6772 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6773 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6774 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6775 point will go to the beginning of the file.
6776
6777 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6778 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6779 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6780
6781 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6782 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6783 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6784
6785 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6786 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6787 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6788
6789 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6790
6791 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6792
6793 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6794 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6795 expression from that list, are not checked.
6796
6797 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6798 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6799 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6800 the buffer, just like for the local files.
6801
6802 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6803
6804 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6805 displays local abbrevs, only.
6806
6807 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6808 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6809
6810 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6811 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6812 is measured in pixels.
6813
6814 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6815 to be visited as images.
6816
6817 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6818 were added to compile.el.
6819
6820 ** Withdrawn packages
6821
6822 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6823 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
6824
6825 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6826
6827 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
6828
6829 \f
6830 * Incompatible Lisp changes
6831
6832 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6833 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
6834 See the sections below for details.
6835
6836 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
6837 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
6838 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6839 to remove the properties of the copy.
6840
6841 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6842 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6843 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6844 these properties are active.
6845
6846 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
6847 ranges may affect some code.
6848
6849 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6850 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6851 make a difference to some code.
6852
6853 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6854 operates on the minibuffer.
6855
6856 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6857 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6858 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6859 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6860 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6861 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6862 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6863 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6864 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6865 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6866 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6867 the buffer as multibyte characters.
6868
6869 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6870 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6871 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6872
6873 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
6874 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6875 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
6876
6877 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
6878 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6879 such as `mapconcat'.
6880
6881 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6882 string.
6883
6884 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6885 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6886 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6887 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6888 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6889 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
6890 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6891 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
6892
6893 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6894 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6895 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6896 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6897 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6898 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6899 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6900 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6901 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6902 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
6903
6904 \f
6905 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6906 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6907
6908 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6909
6910 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
6911 allows the animated display of strings.
6912
6913 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6914 interactive form of a function.
6915
6916 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6917 between custom options. Example:
6918
6919 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6920 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6921 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6922 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6923 :group 'mule
6924 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6925 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6926
6927 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6928 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6929 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6930
6931 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
6932 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6933 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6934 (signal or normal termination).
6935
6936 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6937 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6938
6939 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6940 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6941
6942 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6943 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6944
6945 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
6946
6947 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6948 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6949 being deleted.
6950
6951 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6952
6953 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
6954 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6955 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6956 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6957 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6958 charset.
6959
6960 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6961 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6962 message.
6963
6964 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6965 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6966
6967 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6968 with the more general `:mask' property.
6969
6970 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
6971
6972 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6973 backslash.
6974
6975 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6976 is running in batch mode. For example,
6977
6978 (message "%s" (read t))
6979
6980 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6981 to standard output.
6982
6983 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6984 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6985
6986 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6987 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6988 frame or window.
6989
6990 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6991 were added
6992
6993 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
6994
6995 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
6996 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
6997
6998 - Function: remq ELT LIST
6999
7000 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7001 comparison is done with `eq'.
7002
7003 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7004
7005 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7006 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7007 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7008
7009 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7010 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7011 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7012
7013 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7014 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7015
7016 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7017 function was declared obsolete.
7018
7019 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7020 retained as an alias).
7021
7022 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7023 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7024
7025 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7026
7027 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7028
7029 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7030 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7031 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7032 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7033 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7034 means never include the minibuffer window.
7035
7036 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7037
7038 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7039
7040 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7041
7042 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7043 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7044 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7045 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7046 returned.
7047
7048 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7049 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7050 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7051 minibuffer even if it is active.
7052
7053 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7054 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7055 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7056 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7057 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7058 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7059
7060 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7061 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7062 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7063 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7064 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7065 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7066 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7067
7068 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7069 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7070 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7071
7072 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7073 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7074 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7075 Default value is nil.
7076
7077 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7078 meaning no limit.
7079
7080 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7081 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7082 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7083
7084 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7085 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7086 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7087
7088 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7089 list of a primitive.
7090
7091 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7092
7093 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7094 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7095 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7096 than replacing the local map.
7097
7098 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7099 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7100 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7101 instead.
7102
7103 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7104
7105 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7106 as promised long ago.
7107
7108 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7109
7110 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7111 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7112 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7113
7114 \f
7115 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7116
7117 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7118 regular expressions.
7119
7120 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7121
7122 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7123
7124 - Macro: rx SEXP
7125
7126 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7127
7128 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7129 notation.
7130
7131 STRING
7132 matches string STRING literally.
7133
7134 CHAR
7135 matches character CHAR literally.
7136
7137 `not-newline'
7138 matches any character except a newline.
7139 .
7140 `anything'
7141 matches any character
7142
7143 `(any SET)'
7144 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7145 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7146
7147 '(in SET)'
7148 like `any'.
7149
7150 `(not (any SET))'
7151 matches any character not in SET
7152
7153 `line-start'
7154 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7155 in the text being matched
7156
7157 `line-end'
7158 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7159
7160 `string-start'
7161 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7162 string being matched against.
7163
7164 `string-end'
7165 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7166 string being matched against.
7167
7168 `buffer-start'
7169 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7170 buffer being matched against.
7171
7172 `buffer-end'
7173 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7174 buffer being matched against.
7175
7176 `point'
7177 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7178
7179 `word-start'
7180 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7181 word.
7182
7183 `word-end'
7184 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7185
7186 `word-boundary'
7187 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7188 word.
7189
7190 `(not word-boundary)'
7191 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7192 word.
7193
7194 `digit'
7195 matches 0 through 9.
7196
7197 `control'
7198 matches ASCII control characters.
7199
7200 `hex-digit'
7201 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7202
7203 `blank'
7204 matches space and tab only.
7205
7206 `graphic'
7207 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7208 space, and DEL.
7209
7210 `printing'
7211 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7212 and DEL.
7213
7214 `alphanumeric'
7215 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7216 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7217
7218 `letter'
7219 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7220 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7221
7222 `ascii'
7223 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7224
7225 `nonascii'
7226 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7227
7228 `lower'
7229 matches anything lower-case.
7230
7231 `upper'
7232 matches anything upper-case.
7233
7234 `punctuation'
7235 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7236 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7237
7238 `space'
7239 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7240
7241 `word'
7242 matches anything that has word syntax.
7243
7244 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7245 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7246 of the following symbols.
7247
7248 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7249 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7250 `word' (\\sw)
7251 `symbol' (\\s_)
7252 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7253 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7254 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7255 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7256 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7257 `escape' (\\s\\)
7258 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7259 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7260 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7261
7262 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7263 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7264
7265 `(category CATEGORY)'
7266 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7267 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7268
7269 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7270 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7271 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7272 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7273 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7274 `symbol' (\\c5)
7275 `digit' (\\c6)
7276 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7277 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7278 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7279 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7280 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7281 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7282 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7283 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7284 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7285 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7286 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7287 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7288 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7289 `ascii' (\\ca)
7290 `arabic' (\\cb)
7291 `chinese' (\\cc)
7292 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7293 `greek' (\\cg)
7294 `korean' (\\ch)
7295 `indian' (\\ci)
7296 `japanese' (\\cj)
7297 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7298 `latin' (\\cl)
7299 `lao' (\\co)
7300 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7301 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7302 `thai' (\\ct)
7303 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7304 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7305 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7306 `can-break' (\\c|)
7307
7308 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7309 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7310
7311 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7312 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7313
7314 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7315 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7316 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7317
7318 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7319 another name for `submatch'.
7320
7321 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7322 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7323 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7324 regular expression.
7325
7326 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7327 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7328 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7329 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7330 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7331
7332 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7333 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7334
7335 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7336 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7337
7338 `(0+ SEXP)'
7339 like `zero-or-more'.
7340
7341 `(* SEXP)'
7342 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7343
7344 `(*? SEXP)'
7345 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7346
7347 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7348 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7349
7350 `(1+ SEXP)'
7351 like `one-or-more'.
7352
7353 `(+ SEXP)'
7354 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7355
7356 `(+? SEXP)'
7357 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7358
7359 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7360 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7361
7362 `(optional SEXP)'
7363 like `zero-or-one'.
7364
7365 `(? SEXP)'
7366 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7367
7368 `(?? SEXP)'
7369 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7370
7371 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7372 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7373
7374 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7375 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7376
7377 `(eval FORM)'
7378 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7379 `regexp-quote' it.
7380
7381 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7382 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7383
7384 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7385
7386 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7387 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7388 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7389 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7390
7391 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7392 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7393 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7394 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7395
7396 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7397 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7398 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7399
7400 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7401 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7402 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7403 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7404 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7405 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7406 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7407 eight-bit-graphic.
7408
7409 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7410
7411 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7412 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7413 character set as previously.
7414
7415 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7416 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7417 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7418
7419 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7420 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7421 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7422 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7423
7424 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7425 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7426
7427 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7428 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7429 "fontset-default".
7430
7431 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7432 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7433
7434 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7435 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7436 buffers and strings.
7437
7438 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7439 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7440 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7441 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7442 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7443 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7444 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7445 also been deleted.
7446
7447 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7448 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7449 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7450
7451 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7452 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7453 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7454 may differ between buffer and string text.
7455
7456 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7457 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7458
7459 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7460 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7461 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7462 `composition' from STRING.
7463
7464 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7465 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7466
7467 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7468 obsolete.
7469
7470 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7471 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7472
7473 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7474 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7475 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7476 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7477
7478 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7479 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7480 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7481 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7482 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7483 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7484
7485 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7486 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7487 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7488
7489 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7490 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7491 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7492
7493 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7494 have been introduced.
7495
7496 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7497 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7498 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7499 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7500 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7501 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7502 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7503 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7504 their multibyte equivalent.
7505
7506 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7507 that offset in the file before writing.
7508
7509 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7510 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7511
7512 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7513 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7514 from which the command was issued.
7515
7516 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7517 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7518 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7519 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7520 operate on.
7521
7522 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7523 to `window-buffer-height'.
7524
7525 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7526
7527 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7528 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7529 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7530
7531 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7532 respectively.
7533
7534 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
7535 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7536
7537 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7538 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7539 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7540
7541 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7542 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7543 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7544 is currently displayed in some window.
7545
7546 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7547 argument function's results.
7548
7549 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
7550 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
7551 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
7552 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
7553 sequence).
7554
7555 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
7556 header in the list of headers passed to it.
7557
7558 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7559 ignores differences in case and text representation.
7560
7561 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
7562 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7563 as follows:
7564
7565 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7566 nil don't display a cursor
7567 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7568 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7569 others display a box cursor.
7570
7571 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7572 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7573 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7574 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7575
7576 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
7577 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
7578 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7579 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7580
7581 Example:
7582
7583 (string-to-syntax "()")
7584 => (4 . 41)
7585
7586 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7587 other than 10.
7588
7589 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7590 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7591
7592 #b1111
7593 => 15
7594 #b-1111
7595 => -15
7596
7597 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7598
7599 #o666
7600 => 438
7601
7602 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7603
7604 #xbeef
7605 => 48815
7606
7607 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7608
7609 #2R-111
7610 => -7
7611 #25rah
7612 => 267
7613
7614 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
7615 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
7616 and isn't a string.
7617
7618 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7619 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7620 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7621 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7622
7623 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7624
7625 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
7626 for a regexp in a string.
7627
7628 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7629 `mouse-position-function'.
7630
7631 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7632 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7633
7634 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7635 Keywords are now always considered constants.
7636
7637 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7638 returns it.
7639
7640 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7641 returned by function `recent-keys'.
7642
7643 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7644 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
7645 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
7646 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7647 mode.
7648
7649 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7650 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7651
7652 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7653 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7654 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7655 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7656 been performed."
7657
7658 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7659 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7660 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7661 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
7662
7663 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7664 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7665 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7666
7667 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7668 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7669 specified table.
7670
7671 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7672
7673 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
7674 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7675 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7676 what BODY returns.
7677
7678 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
7679 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
7680 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
7681 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7682 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
7683
7684 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7685 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7686
7687 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7688 instead of being optional.
7689
7690 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7691 modify read-only text.
7692
7693 ** New functions and variables for locales.
7694
7695 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7696 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
7697 time functions like strftime. The new variables
7698 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7699 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
7700
7701 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7702 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7703 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
7704 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7705 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7706 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7707 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
7708
7709 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7710 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7711 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7712 start sequences.
7713
7714 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7715 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7716
7717 ** New function `propertize'
7718
7719 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7720 strings with text properties.
7721
7722 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7723
7724 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7725 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7726 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7727 specified value of that property. Example:
7728
7729 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7730
7731 ** push and pop macros.
7732
7733 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7734 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
7735 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7736
7737 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7738 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7739 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7740
7741 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7742
7743 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7744 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
7745
7746 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7747 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7748 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7749 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7750
7751 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7752 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7753 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7754 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7755
7756 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7757 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7758 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7759 or a sign.
7760
7761 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7762 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7763 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7764 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
7765 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7766 space, and DEL.
7767 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7768 and DEL.
7769 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7770 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7771 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7772 [:alpha:] matches letters.
7773 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7774 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7775 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7776 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7777 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7778 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
7779 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7780 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7781 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7782 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7783 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7784
7785 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7786
7787 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7788
7789 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7790
7791 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7792 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7793
7794 :test TEST
7795
7796 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7797 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7798 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7799
7800 :size SIZE
7801
7802 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7803 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7804
7805 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7806
7807 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7808 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7809 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
7810 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7811 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7812
7813 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7814
7815 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7816 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7817 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7818
7819 :weakness WEAK
7820
7821 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7822 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7823 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7824 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7825 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
7826
7827 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
7828
7829 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7830
7831 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7832
7833 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7834
7835 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7836
7837 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7838 values are shared.
7839
7840 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7841
7842 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7843
7844 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7845
7846 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7847
7848 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7849
7850 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7851
7852 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7853
7854 Returns the size of TABLE.
7855
7856 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
7857
7858 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7859
7860 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7861
7862 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7863
7864 - Function: clrhash TABLE
7865
7866 Clear TABLE.
7867
7868 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7869
7870 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7871 not found.
7872
7873 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
7874
7875 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7876 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7877
7878 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7879
7880 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7881
7882 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7883
7884 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7885 arguments KEY and VALUE.
7886
7887 - Function: sxhash OBJ
7888
7889 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7890
7891 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7892
7893 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7894 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
7895 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
7896 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7897 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7898
7899 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7900
7901 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7902 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7903 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7904
7905 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7906 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7907
7908 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7909 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7910
7911 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7912 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7913
7914 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
7915 'case-fold-string-hash))
7916
7917 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7918
7919 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7920
7921 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7922 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7923 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7924
7925 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7926
7927 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7928 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7929
7930 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7931 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7932 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7933 is too short to reach that column.
7934
7935 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7936 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7937 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7938 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7939
7940 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7941 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7942 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7943
7944 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7945 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7946
7947 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7948 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7949
7950 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7951 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7952 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7953 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7954 temporary-file-directory instead.
7955
7956 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7957 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7958 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7959 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7960
7961 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7962 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
7963
7964 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7965
7966 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7967 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7968 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7969
7970 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7971
7972 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7973 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7974 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7975 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7976 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7977 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7978
7979 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7980 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7981 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7982 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7983
7984 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7985
7986 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7987 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7988 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7989 result string.
7990
7991 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7992 string where arguments appear in the result string.
7993
7994 Example:
7995
7996 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
7997 (s2 "world"))
7998 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
7999 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8000 (format s1 s2))
8001
8002 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8003
8004 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8005
8006 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8007 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8008 argument in it.
8009
8010 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8011 (arg "world"))
8012 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8013 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8014 (message msg arg))
8015
8016 ** Sound support
8017
8018 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8019 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8020
8021 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8022 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8023 to enable sound support.
8024
8025 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8026 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8027 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8028 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8029 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8030
8031 The following sound properties are supported:
8032
8033 - `:file FILE'
8034
8035 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8036 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8037
8038 - `:data DATA'
8039
8040 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8041 may be present, but not both.
8042
8043 - `:volume VOLUME'
8044
8045 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8046 0..1. This property is optional.
8047
8048 - `:device DEVICE'
8049
8050 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8051 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8052
8053 Other properties are ignored.
8054
8055 An alternative interface is called as
8056 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8057
8058 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8059
8060 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8061 a keyword symbol.
8062
8063 ** Changes to garbage collection
8064
8065 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8066 of live and free strings.
8067
8068 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8069 strings that have been consed so far.
8070
8071 \f
8072 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8073 Lisp Manual
8074
8075 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8076 mini-windows.
8077
8078 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8079 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8080 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8081
8082 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8083
8084 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8085
8086 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8087 image.
8088
8089 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8090
8091 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8092
8093 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8094 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8095 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8096 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8097 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8098
8099 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8100 has a mask bitmap.
8101
8102 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8103
8104 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8105 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8106 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8107
8108 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8109 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8110
8111 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8112 optional.
8113
8114 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8115 below).
8116
8117 \f
8118 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8119
8120 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8121 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8122
8123 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8124 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8125 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8126 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8127 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8128 just display it black instead.
8129
8130 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8131 a line like
8132
8133 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8134
8135 in your `.emacs'.
8136
8137 ** New face implementation.
8138
8139 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8140 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8141
8142 *** New faces.
8143
8144 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8145
8146 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8147
8148 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8149 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8150
8151 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8152
8153 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8154
8155 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8156
8157 6. Foreground color.
8158
8159 7. Background color.
8160
8161 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8162
8163 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8164
8165 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8166
8167 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8168
8169 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8170 color.
8171
8172 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8173 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8174
8175 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8176 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8177 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8178 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8179 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8180 attributes mentioned above.
8181
8182 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8183 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8184 created frames.
8185
8186 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8187 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8188 `fully-specified'.
8189
8190 *** Face merging.
8191
8192 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8193 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8194 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8195 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8196 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8197 results in a fully-specified face.
8198
8199 *** Face realization.
8200
8201 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8202 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8203 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8204 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8205 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8206 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8207
8208 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8209 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8210 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8211 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8212
8213 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8214 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8215 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8216 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8217 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8218
8219 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8220 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8221 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8222 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8223 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8224 Emacs.
8225
8226 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8227 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8228 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8229 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8230
8231 **** Clearing face caches.
8232
8233 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8234 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8235 unused fonts.
8236
8237 *** Font selection.
8238
8239 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8240 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8241 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8242
8243 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8244 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8245 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8246 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8247 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8248
8249 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8250 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8251 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8252
8253 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8254
8255 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8256 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8257 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8258 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8259 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8260 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8261 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8262
8263 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8264 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8265 doesn't exist.
8266
8267 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8268 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8269 registry.
8270
8271 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8272 slightly different.
8273
8274 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8275
8276
8277 **** Scalable fonts
8278
8279 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8280 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8281 servers.
8282
8283 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8284 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8285 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8286 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8287 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8288 that list. Example:
8289
8290 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8291
8292 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8293
8294 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8295
8296 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8297
8298 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8299 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8300 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8301
8302 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8303 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8304 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8305 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8306 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8307 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8308 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8309 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8310 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8311 of the face font sort order.
8312
8313 - Function: x-font-family-list
8314
8315 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8316 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8317 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8318 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8319
8320 - Variable: font-list-limit
8321
8322 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8323 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8324 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8325
8326 *** Setting face attributes.
8327
8328 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8329 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8330 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8331 `face-attribute'.
8332
8333 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8334 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8335
8336 The following attributes are recognized:
8337
8338 `:family'
8339
8340 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8341 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8342 and `?' are allowed.
8343
8344 `:width'
8345
8346 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8347 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8348 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8349 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8350
8351 `:height'
8352
8353 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8354 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8355 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8356 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8357
8358 `:weight'
8359
8360 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8361 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8362 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8363
8364 `:slant'
8365
8366 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8367 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8368 `reverse-oblique'.
8369
8370 `:foreground', `:background'
8371
8372 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8373
8374 `:underline'
8375
8376 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8377 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8378 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8379 don't underline.
8380
8381 `:overline'
8382
8383 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8384 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8385 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8386 overline.
8387
8388 `:strike-through'
8389
8390 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8391 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8392 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8393 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8394
8395 `:box'
8396
8397 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8398 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8399 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8400 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8401 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8402 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8403 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8404 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8405 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8406 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8407 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8408 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8409 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8410 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8411 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8412 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8413 box.
8414
8415 `:inverse-video'
8416
8417 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8418 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8419
8420 `:stipple'
8421
8422 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8423 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8424 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8425 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8426 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8427 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8428
8429 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8430 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8431
8432 `:font'
8433
8434 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8435 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8436 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8437 versions of Emacs.
8438
8439 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8440 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8441 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8442
8443 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8444 `defface'.
8445
8446 `:inherit'
8447
8448 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8449 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8450 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8451
8452 *** Face attributes and X resources
8453
8454 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8455 from X resources:
8456
8457 Face attribute X resource class
8458 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8459 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8460 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8461 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8462 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8463 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8464 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8465 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8466 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8467 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8468 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8469 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8470 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8471 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8472 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8473 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8474 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8475 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8476 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8477 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8478
8479 *** Text property `face'.
8480
8481 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8482 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8483 specification can be
8484
8485 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8486
8487 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8488 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8489 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8490 for face attribute names.
8491
8492 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8493 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8494 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8495
8496 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8497
8498 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8499 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8500 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8501 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8502 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8503 used to clear the mapping table.
8504
8505 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8506
8507 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8508 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8509 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8510 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8511 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8512 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8513 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8514 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8515 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8516 modify their color-related behavior.
8517
8518 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8519 any frame type.
8520
8521 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8522
8523 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8524 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8525 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8526 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8527 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8528 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8529 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8530 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8531 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8532
8533 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8534 display can display image files.
8535
8536 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
8537
8538 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
8539 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8540 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8541 `Inviolable' option.
8542
8543 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
8544 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
8545 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
8546
8547 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8548
8549 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8550 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
8551 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
8552
8553 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
8554 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
8555 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
8556 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
8557 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8558 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8559 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8560 functions.
8561
8562 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
8563 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
8564 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
8565
8566 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8567
8568 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
8569
8570 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
8571
8572 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8573 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
8574 constrained position if that is different.
8575
8576 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8577 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8578 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
8579 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
8580 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8581 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
8582 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8583 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8584 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
8585
8586 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8587 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8588 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8589 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8590 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8591
8592 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8593 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8594
8595 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8596
8597 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
8598
8599 Delete the field surrounding POS.
8600 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8601 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8602
8603 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8604
8605 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8606 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8607 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8608 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
8609 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8610
8611 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8612
8613 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8614 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8615 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8616 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
8617 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8618
8619 - Function: field-string &optional POS
8620
8621 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8622 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8623 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8624
8625 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8626
8627 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8628 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8629 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8630
8631 ** Image support.
8632
8633 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8634 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8635 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8636 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8637
8638 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8639 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8640 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8641 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8642 area.
8643
8644 IMAGE is an image specification.
8645
8646 *** Image specifications
8647
8648 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8649 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8650 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
8651 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8652 described below are ignored.
8653
8654 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8655
8656 `:ascent ASCENT'
8657
8658 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8659 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
8660 to use for its ascent.
8661
8662 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8663 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8664
8665 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
8666 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8667 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8668 overlays that apply to the image.
8669
8670 `:margin MARGIN'
8671
8672 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8673 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8674 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
8675
8676 `:relief RELIEF'
8677
8678 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8679 around an image.
8680
8681 `:conversion ALGO'
8682
8683 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8684
8685 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8686 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8687
8688 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8689 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8690 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8691 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8692 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8693 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8694 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8695 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8696 below.
8697
8698 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8699 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8700 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8701
8702 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8703 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8704 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8705 of the factors' absolute values.
8706
8707 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
8708
8709 (1 0 0
8710 0 0 0
8711 9 9 -1)
8712
8713 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8714
8715 ( 2 -1 0
8716 -1 0 1
8717 0 1 -2)
8718
8719 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8720 ``disabled''.
8721
8722 `:mask MASK'
8723
8724 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8725 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8726 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8727 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8728 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
8729 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8730 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8731 image.
8732
8733 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8734 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8735 `:mask nil'.
8736
8737 `:file FILE'
8738
8739 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8740 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8741 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8742 may be present in the image specification.
8743
8744 `:data DATA'
8745
8746 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8747 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8748 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8749 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8750
8751 *** Supported image types
8752
8753 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
8754
8755 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
8756 properties supported are:
8757
8758 `:foreground FG'
8759
8760 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8761 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8762
8763 `:background BG'
8764
8765 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8766 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8767
8768 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8769 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8770 instead of a `:file' property.
8771
8772 `:width WIDTH'
8773
8774 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8775
8776 `:height HEIGHT'
8777
8778 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8779
8780 `:data DATA'
8781
8782 DATA must be either
8783
8784 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8785 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8786
8787 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8788
8789 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8790 bitmap.
8791
8792 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8793 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8794 in the file.
8795
8796 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
8797
8798 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8799 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8800 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8801 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8802
8803 Additional image properties supported are:
8804
8805 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8806
8807 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8808 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8809 name.
8810
8811 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8812 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8813
8814 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8815 to display compressed images.
8816
8817 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
8818
8819 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
8820 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
8821 mono images are:
8822
8823 `:foreground FG'
8824
8825 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8826 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8827
8828 `:background FG'
8829
8830 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8831 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8832
8833 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8834
8835 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
8836 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8837 properties defined.
8838
8839 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8840
8841 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8842 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8843 properties defined.
8844
8845 **** GIF, image type `gif'
8846
8847 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8848 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8849
8850 Additional image properties supported are:
8851
8852 `:index INDEX'
8853
8854 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
8855 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8856 as a hollow box.
8857
8858 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8859 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8860 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8861 every 0.1 seconds.
8862
8863 (defun show-anim (file max)
8864 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8865 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8866
8867 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8868 (when (= idx max)
8869 (setq idx 0))
8870 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
8871 (save-excursion
8872 (set-buffer buffer)
8873 (goto-char (point-min))
8874 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8875 (insert-image img "x"))
8876 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8877
8878 **** PNG, image type `png'
8879
8880 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8881 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8882 properties defined.
8883
8884 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8885
8886 Additional image properties supported are:
8887
8888 `:pt-width WIDTH'
8889
8890 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
8891 integer. This is a required property.
8892
8893 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
8894
8895 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
8896 must be a integer. This is an required property.
8897
8898 `:bounding-box BOX'
8899
8900 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8901 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8902 files. This is an required property.
8903
8904 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8905 lisp/gs.el.
8906
8907 *** Lisp interface.
8908
8909 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8910 which are supported in the current configuration.
8911
8912 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8913 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8914 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
8915 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8916 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
8917
8918 *** Simplified image API, image.el
8919
8920 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8921 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8922 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8923 define an image based on available image types. The functions
8924 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8925 buffer.
8926
8927 ** Display margins.
8928
8929 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8930 and images.
8931
8932 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8933 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8934 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8935 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8936 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8937 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8938 of the display margins.
8939
8940 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8941 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8942 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8943 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8944 in this file).
8945
8946 ** Help display
8947
8948 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8949 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8950 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8951 that have a `help-echo' property.
8952
8953 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
8954 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
8955 the window in which the help was found.
8956
8957 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8958 `help-echo' text property was found.
8959
8960 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8961 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8962
8963 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
8964 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
8965 mouse.
8966
8967 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8968 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8969
8970 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8971 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8972 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8973 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8974 used as help string.
8975
8976 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
8977 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8978 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
8979
8980 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8981
8982 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8983 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8984
8985 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8986 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8987 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8988 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8989 used.
8990
8991 (global-set-key [A-down]
8992 #'(lambda ()
8993 (interactive)
8994 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
8995 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
8996 (global-set-key [A-up]
8997 #'(lambda ()
8998 (interactive)
8999 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9000 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9001
9002 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9003
9004 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9005 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9006 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9007 is called with one argument, POS.
9008
9009 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9010 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9011 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9012 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9013 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9014
9015 ** Tool bar support.
9016
9017 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9018 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9019 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9020 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9021 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9022 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9023
9024 *** Tool bar item definitions
9025
9026 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9027 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9028 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9029
9030 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9031 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9032 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9033 property (see below).
9034
9035 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9036 binding are currently ignored.
9037
9038 The following properties are recognized:
9039
9040 `:enable FORM'.
9041
9042 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9043 or disabled.
9044
9045 `:visible FORM'
9046
9047 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9048
9049 `:filter FUNCTION'
9050
9051 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9052 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9053 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9054
9055 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9056
9057 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9058 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9059
9060 `:image IMAGES'
9061
9062 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9063 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9064 meaning of each of the four elements:
9065
9066 Index Use when item is
9067 ----------------------------------------
9068 0 enabled and selected
9069 1 enabled and deselected
9070 2 disabled and selected
9071 3 disabled and deselected
9072
9073 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9074 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9075
9076 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9077
9078 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9079 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9080
9081 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9082 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9083 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9084 menu bar.
9085
9086 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9087 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9088 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9089
9090 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9091
9092 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9093 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9094 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9095
9096 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9097 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9098
9099 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9100 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9101 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9102 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9103
9104 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9105 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9106
9107 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9108
9109 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9110 a tool bar item. If
9111
9112 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9113 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9114 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9115
9116 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9117
9118 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9119
9120 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9121 item.
9122
9123 ** Mode line changes.
9124
9125 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9126
9127 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9128 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9129 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9130
9131 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9132 a `local-map' text property.
9133
9134 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9135 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9136
9137 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9138 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9139 `local-map' property.
9140
9141 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9142 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9143 example.
9144
9145 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9146 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9147
9148 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9149 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9150
9151 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9152
9153 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9154 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9155 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9156 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9157 line.
9158
9159 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9160 `header-line'.
9161
9162 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9163 position in the header-line.
9164
9165 ** Text property `display'
9166
9167 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9168 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9169 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9170 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9171 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9172
9173 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9174
9175 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9176 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9177
9178 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9179 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9180 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9181 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9182 simpler form STRING as property value.
9183
9184 *** Variable width and height spaces
9185
9186 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9187 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9188 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9189 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9190 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9191 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9192 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9193
9194 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9195 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9196 properties described below.
9197
9198 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9199 characters having the `display' property.
9200
9201 - :width WIDTH
9202
9203 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9204 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9205
9206 - :relative-width FACTOR
9207
9208 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9209 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9210 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9211 width of that character by FACTOR.
9212
9213 - :align-to HPOS
9214
9215 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9216 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9217
9218 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9219
9220 - :height HEIGHT
9221
9222 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9223 normal line height.
9224
9225 - :relative-height FACTOR
9226
9227 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9228 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9229
9230 - :ascent ASCENT
9231
9232 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9233 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9234 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9235 equal to 100.
9236
9237 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9238
9239 *** Images
9240
9241 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9242 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9243 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9244 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9245 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9246 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9247 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9248 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9249 as display specification.
9250
9251 *** Other display properties
9252
9253 - (space-width FACTOR)
9254
9255 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9256 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9257 integer or float.
9258
9259 - (height HEIGHT)
9260
9261 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9262
9263 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9264 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9265 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9266 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9267 a font is available counts as a step.
9268
9269 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9270 as tall as the frame's default font.
9271
9272 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9273 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9274
9275 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9276 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9277
9278 - (raise FACTOR)
9279
9280 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9281 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9282 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9283 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9284 `height' subproperty.
9285
9286 *** Conditional display properties
9287
9288 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9289 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9290 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9291 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9292 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9293 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9294 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9295 different when object is a string.
9296
9297 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9298 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9299
9300 ** New menu separator types.
9301
9302 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9303 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9304 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9305 to specify other menu separator types.
9306
9307 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9308
9309 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9310 separator occurs.
9311
9312 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9313
9314 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9315
9316 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9317
9318 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9319
9320 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9321
9322 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9323
9324 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9325
9326 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9327
9328 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9329
9330 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9331 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9332
9333 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9334
9335 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9336
9337 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9338
9339 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9340
9341 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9342
9343 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9344
9345 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9346
9347 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9348
9349 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9350
9351 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9352
9353 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9354
9355 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9356
9357 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9358
9359 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9360
9361 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9362 the corresponding single-line separators.
9363
9364 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9365
9366 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9367 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9368 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9369 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9370 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9371 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9372 default foreground is black.
9373
9374 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9375 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9376 `ScrollBarBackground').
9377
9378 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9379 settings for scroll bar colors.
9380
9381 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9382 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9383
9384 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9385 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9386 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9387 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9388 the original window start.
9389
9390 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9391 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9392 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9393
9394 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9395
9396 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9397 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9398 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9399 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9400
9401 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9402 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9403
9404 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9405
9406 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9407 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9408 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9409 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9410 temporarily to nil, for example
9411
9412 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9413 (enlarge-window 10))
9414
9415 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9416 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9417
9418 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9419 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9420 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9421 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9422 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9423 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9424
9425
9426 \f
9427 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9428
9429 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9430 input.
9431
9432 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9433
9434 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9435
9436 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9437 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9438 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9439 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9440 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9441
9442 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9443 been added.
9444
9445 \f
9446 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9447
9448 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9449
9450
9451 \f
9452 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9453
9454 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9455 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9456 \f
9457 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9458
9459 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9460
9461 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9462 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9463 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9464
9465 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9466 is the one that is used.
9467
9468 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9469 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9470 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9471 separate from the command's regular output.
9472 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9473 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9474 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9475 the buffer name.
9476
9477 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9478 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9479 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9480 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9481
9482 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9483 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9484 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9485 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9486
9487 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9488 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9489 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9490 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9491
9492 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9493 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9494 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9495 they never ignore case.
9496
9497 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9498 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9499 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9500 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9501 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9502 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9503 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9504
9505 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9506 the same format that was used in the file before.
9507
9508 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9509 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9510
9511 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9512 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9513 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9514
9515 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9516 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9517 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9518 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9519 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9520 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9521 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9522
9523 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9524 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9525 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9526 format. You can now customize these variables.
9527
9528 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9529 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9530 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9531 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9532
9533 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9534 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9535 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9536
9537 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9538 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9539 doesn't have any effect.
9540
9541 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9542 not one per buffer.
9543
9544 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9545 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9546 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9547
9548 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9549 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9550 `auto-show-mode' command.
9551
9552 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9553 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9554 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9555 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9556 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9557
9558 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9559 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9560
9561 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9562 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9563 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9564
9565 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9566 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9567 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9568 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9569
9570 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9571
9572 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9573 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9574 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9575 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9576 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9577
9578 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9579 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9580
9581 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9582 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9583 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9584 `?' on other systems.
9585
9586 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9587 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9588 Unix.
9589
9590 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9591 current codepage when it starts.
9592
9593 ** Mail changes
9594
9595 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9596 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9597 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9598 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9599 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9600 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9601 latin-1:
9602
9603 MIME-version: 1.0
9604 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9605 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9606
9607 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9608 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9609 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9610 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9611 buffer-file-coding-system.
9612
9613 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9614 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9615 mail.
9616
9617 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9618 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9619 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9620 list of possible coding systems.
9621
9622 ** CC Mode changes
9623
9624 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9625 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9626 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9627 docstring for details.
9628
9629 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9630 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9631 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9632 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9633 lineup functions use this feature currently.
9634
9635 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9636 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9637
9638 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9639 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9640
9641 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9642 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9643 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9644 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9645 anonymous classes.
9646
9647 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9648 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9649
9650 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9651 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9652 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9653 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9654
9655 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9656 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9657 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9658 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9659 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9660
9661 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9662
9663 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9664
9665 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9666 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9667
9668 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9669
9670 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9671 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9672 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9673 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9674 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9675
9676 ** Gnus changes.
9677
9678 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9679 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9680 Gnus manual for the full story.
9681
9682 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9683 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9684 group, which is created automatically.
9685
9686 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9687 values.
9688
9689 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9690
9691 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9692 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9693
9694 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9695 `C-u C-c C-c'.
9696
9697 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9698
9699 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9700 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9701
9702 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9703
9704 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9705 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9706
9707 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9708 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9709
9710 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9711 control over simplification.
9712
9713 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9714
9715 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9716 limit.
9717
9718 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9719
9720 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9721
9722 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9723 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9724 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9725
9726 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
9727 `a' forces normal posting method.
9728
9729 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9730 -- `W d'.
9731
9732 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9733 to a non-nil value.
9734
9735 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9736 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9737
9738 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9739 has been added.
9740
9741 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9742
9743 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9744
9745 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9746 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9747
9748 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9749 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9750
9751 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9752
9753 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9754 been added.
9755
9756 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9757 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9758
9759 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9760 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9761
9762 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9763
9764 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9765
9766 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9767
9768 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9769
9770 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9771 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9772 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9773
9774 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9775 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9776 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9777 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9778 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9779
9780 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9781 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9782 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9783 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9784
9785 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9786 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9787 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9788 mismatch.
9789
9790 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9791
9792 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9793 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9794
9795 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9796 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9797 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9798 removed from the label.
9799
9800 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9801 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9802
9803 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9804 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9805
9806 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9807 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9808 expressions.
9809
9810 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9811
9812 ** New/deleted modes and packages
9813
9814 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9815 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9816
9817 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9818 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9819 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9820
9821 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9822 changes with a special face.
9823
9824 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9825 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9826 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
9827 \f
9828 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9829
9830 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9831 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9832 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9833 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9834 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9835
9836 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9837 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9838 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9839
9840 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9841 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9842 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9843 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9844 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9845 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9846 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9847 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9848 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9849
9850 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9851 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9852 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9853 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9854 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9855 program.
9856
9857 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9858 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9859 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9860 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9861 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9862 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9863
9864 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9865 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9866 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9867 was not documented clearly before.
9868
9869 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9870 This includes Tetris and Snake.
9871 \f
9872 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9873
9874 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9875 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9876 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9877 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9878
9879 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9880 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9881 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9882
9883 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9884
9885 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9886 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9887
9888 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9889 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9890 integers.
9891
9892 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9893 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9894 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9895 file names and attributes are returned.
9896
9897 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9898 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
9899 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
9900 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9901 returns the result.
9902
9903 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9904 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9905
9906 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
9907
9908 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9909 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9910 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9911 optionally.
9912
9913 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9914 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9915
9916 **
9917 The new function process-running-child-p
9918 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9919 terminal to its own child process.
9920
9921 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9922 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9923 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9924 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9925
9926 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9927 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9928
9929 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
9930 :included is an alias for :visible.
9931
9932 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9933 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9934 to move or copy menu entries.
9935
9936 ** Multibyte editing changes
9937
9938 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9939 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9940 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9941 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9942 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9943 (setq char (sref str idx)
9944 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9945 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9946
9947 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9948 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9949 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9950
9951 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9952 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9953 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9954
9955 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
9956
9957 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9958 across the boundary.
9959
9960 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9961 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9962 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9963 contains 8-bit characters.
9964 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9965 contains invalid characters.
9966
9967 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9968 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9969 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9970 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9971 way.
9972
9973 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9974 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9975 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9976 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9977
9978 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9979 compose Thai characters in a string.
9980
9981 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9982 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9983 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9984 menus should always use the third argument.
9985
9986 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9987 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9988 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9989 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9990
9991 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9992 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
9993 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
9994 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
9995
9996 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
9997 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
9998 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
9999 echo area contents.
10000
10001 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10002
10003 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10004 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10005 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10006
10007 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10008 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10009 means to clear out that attribute.
10010
10011 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10012 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10013
10014 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10015 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10016 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10017 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10018
10019 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10020 the gap of the current buffer.
10021
10022 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10023 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10024 current buffer.
10025
10026 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10027 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10028 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10029 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10030 \f
10031 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10032
10033 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10034 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10035 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10036 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10037 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10038
10039 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10040 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10041 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10042 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10043 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10044
10045 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10046 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10047 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10048
10049 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10050 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10051 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10052 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10053 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10054 results.
10055
10056 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10057 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10058 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10059 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10060 \f
10061 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10062
10063 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10064 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10065 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10066 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10067
10068 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10069 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10070 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10071 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10072 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10073 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10074 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10075 region.
10076
10077 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10078 selective undo.
10079
10080 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10081 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10082 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10083 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10084 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10085
10086 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10087 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10088 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10089 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10090
10091 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10092 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10093 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10094 something that most users not do.
10095
10096 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10097 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10098 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10099 applications.
10100
10101 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10102 pasting operations.
10103
10104 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10105 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10106 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10107 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10108 `ps-printer-name'.
10109
10110 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10111 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10112 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10113 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10114 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10115 hits a new word.
10116
10117 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10118 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10119 to be confused by TeX commands.
10120
10121 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10122 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10123 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10124 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10125
10126 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10127 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10128 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10129 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10130 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10131
10132 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10133 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10134
10135 ** Changes in input method usage.
10136
10137 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10138 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10139 respectively.
10140
10141 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10142
10143 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10144 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10145
10146 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10147 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10148
10149 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10150
10151 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10152
10153 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10154 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10155
10156 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10157 given in the following case:
10158 o When you are using a complex input method.
10159 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10160
10161 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10162 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10163 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10164 setting it to t is helpful.
10165
10166 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10167
10168 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10169 keys:
10170 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10171 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10172 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10173 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10174 environment.
10175
10176 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10177 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10178 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10179 get
10180
10181 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10182
10183 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10184
10185 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10186 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10187
10188 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10189 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10190 its owner and group.
10191
10192 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10193 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10194
10195 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10196 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10197
10198 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10199 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10200 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10201 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10202
10203 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10204 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10205 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10206 for writing keyboard macros.
10207
10208 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10209 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10210 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10211 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10212 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10213 info.
10214
10215 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10216
10217 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10218 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10219 contents only.
10220
10221 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10222 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10223 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10224 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10225
10226 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10227 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10228 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10229
10230 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10231 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10232 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10233 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10234
10235 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10236 failure if the command produces no output.
10237
10238 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10239 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10240 the mouse.
10241
10242 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10243 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10244 function and variable names.
10245
10246 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10247 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10248 file-coding-system-alist.
10249
10250 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10251 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10252 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10253 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10254 according to the current fontset.
10255
10256 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10257
10258 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10259 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10260 nonascii-insert-offset.
10261
10262 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10263 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10264 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10265 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10266
10267 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10268 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10269
10270 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10271 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10272
10273 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10274 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10275 command keys.
10276
10277 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10278 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10279
10280 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10281 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10282 all variables that have documentation.
10283
10284 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10285 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10286 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10287 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10288 it should show; the default is 20.
10289
10290 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10291 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10292 of your input.
10293
10294 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10295 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10296 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10297 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10298 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10299 Newly added options are included as well.
10300
10301 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10302 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10303 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10304
10305 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10306 Customize menu.
10307
10308 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10309 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10310
10311 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10312 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10313 invoked.
10314
10315 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10316 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10317 The default is 1.
10318
10319 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10320 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10321 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10322 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10323 sensibly.
10324
10325 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10326
10327 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10328 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10329 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10330
10331 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10332 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10333 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10334 every night.
10335
10336 ** Desktop changes
10337
10338 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10339 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10340
10341 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10342 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10343
10344 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10345 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10346
10347 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10348 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10349 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10350 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10351 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10352 made invisible again.
10353
10354 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10355
10356 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10357 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10358 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10359 toggle.
10360
10361 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10362 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10363 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10364 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10365 rmail-default-body-file.
10366
10367 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10368 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10369 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10370
10371 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10372 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10373 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10374
10375 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10376 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10377 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10378 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10379 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10380 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10381
10382 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10383 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10384 provided by feedmail are:
10385
10386 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10387 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10388 there is also a queue for draft messages
10389
10390 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10391 be prompted for confirmation
10392
10393 **** does smart filling of address headers
10394
10395 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10396 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10397 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10398
10399 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10400 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10401 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10402 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
10403
10404 ** Dired changes
10405
10406 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10407 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10408
10409 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10410 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10411
10412 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10413 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10414 for a specified regexp.
10415
10416 ** VC Changes
10417
10418 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10419 conveniently.
10420
10421 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10422 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10423 Dired.
10424
10425 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10426 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10427 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10428 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10429
10430 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10431 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10432 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10433 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10434 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10435
10436 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10437 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10438 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10439 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10440 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10441
10442 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10443 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10444 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10445 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10446
10447 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10448 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10449 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10450
10451 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10452 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10453 session to resolve them.
10454
10455 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10456 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10457 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10458 uses as well).
10459
10460 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10461 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10462 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10463 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10464 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10465 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10466 using ediff.
10467
10468 ** Changes in Font Lock
10469
10470 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10471 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10472 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10473 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10474 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10475
10476 ** Frame name display changes
10477
10478 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10479 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10480 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10481 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10482
10483 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10484 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10485 menu.
10486
10487 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10488
10489 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10490 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10491 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10492
10493 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10494
10495 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10496 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10497 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10498
10499 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10500 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10501 the following line.
10502
10503 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10504 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10505 previously sent input.
10506
10507 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10508 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10509 as the search string.
10510
10511 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10512 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10513
10514 ** C mode changes
10515
10516 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10517 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10518 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10519 definition.
10520
10521 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10522 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10523 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10524 style is still the default however.
10525
10526 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10527
10528 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10529 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10530 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10531
10532 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10533 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10534
10535 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10536 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10537
10538 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10539 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10540
10541 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10542 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10543
10544 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10545 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10546 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10547 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10548
10549 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
10550
10551 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10552 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10553 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10554
10555 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10556 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10557 expanding dynamically.
10558
10559 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10560 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10561
10562 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10563 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10564 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10565 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10566
10567 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10568
10569 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10570
10571 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10572 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10573 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10574 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10575 against the first word in the title.
10576
10577 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10578 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10579 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10580 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10581 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10582 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10583
10584 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10585 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10586 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10587 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10588
10589 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
10590
10591 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10592 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10593 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10594 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10595 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10596 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10597
10598 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10599 Editing group once the package is loaded.
10600
10601 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10602 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
10603 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
10604
10605 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10606 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10607
10608 ** Ispell changes.
10609
10610 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10611 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10612 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10613
10614 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
10615 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10616 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10617 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10618 include:
10619
10620 o URLs are automatically skipped
10621 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10622
10623 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10624
10625 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10626
10627 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10628 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10629 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10630 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10631
10632 *** New recursive parser.
10633
10634 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10635 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10636 recursive parser scans the individual files.
10637
10638 *** Parsing only part of a document.
10639
10640 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10641 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10642 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10643
10644 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10645
10646 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
10647
10648 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10649
10650 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10651
10652 *** Using multiple selection buffers
10653
10654 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10655 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10656
10657 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10658
10659 *** References to external documents.
10660
10661 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10662 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10663 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10664 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10665 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10666 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10667 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10668
10669 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10670
10671 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
10672 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10673
10674 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10675 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10676
10677 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10678
10679 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10680 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10681
10682 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10683
10684 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10685 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10686 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10687 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10688 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10689 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10690 more.
10691
10692 *** Support for the varioref package
10693
10694 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10695
10696 *** New hooks
10697
10698 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10699 and citations are created. These hooks are
10700 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10701 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
10702
10703 *** Citations outside LaTeX
10704
10705 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10706 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10707
10708 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
10709
10710 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10711 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10712 fontified, use
10713
10714 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10715
10716 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10717 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10718 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10719 directories that contain the same file name.
10720
10721 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10722 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10723 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10724 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10725 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10726 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10727 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10728 directory.
10729
10730 ** New modes and packages
10731
10732 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10733 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10734 it, but some do not.
10735
10736 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10737 code.
10738
10739 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10740 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10741 around in a buffer.
10742
10743 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10744
10745 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10746 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10747 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10748 established system of notation similar to Chess.
10749
10750 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10751 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10752 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10753
10754 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10755 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10756 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10757 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10758 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10759 the like.
10760
10761 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10762 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10763
10764 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10765 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10766 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10767 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10768
10769 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10770
10771 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10772 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10773 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10774 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10775 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10776 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10777 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10778 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10779 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10780 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10781 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10782
10783 Platform-specific modes:
10784
10785 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10786 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10787 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10788 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10789 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10790 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10791 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10792 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10793 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
10794 \f
10795 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10796
10797 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10798 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10799 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10800 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10801
10802 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10803 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10804 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10805
10806 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10807 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10808 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10809 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10810
10811 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10812 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10813 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10814 environment.
10815
10816 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10817 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10818 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10819 current input method for reading this one event.
10820
10821 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10822 now control whether to output certain characters as
10823 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10824 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10825 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10826 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
10827 \f
10828 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10829
10830 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10831 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10832
10833 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10834 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10835 always increases point by 1.
10836
10837 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10838 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10839
10840 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10841
10842 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10843 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10844 default value changed. For example,
10845
10846 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10847 :type 'integer
10848 :group 'foo
10849 :version "20.3")
10850
10851 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10852 :version "20.3")
10853
10854 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10855 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10856 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10857 `:version' in the top level group.
10858
10859 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10860
10861 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10862 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10863
10864 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10865 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10866 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10867 to themselves.
10868
10869 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10870 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10871 values whatever.
10872
10873 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
10874 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10875 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10876
10877 ** Frame-local variables.
10878
10879 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10880 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10881 local bindings for that variable.
10882
10883 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10884 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10885 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10886 parameter name.
10887
10888 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10889 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10890 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10891 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10892
10893 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10894 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10895 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10896 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10897
10898 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10899 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10900 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10901 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10902 See the documentation in sregex.el.
10903
10904 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10905 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10906 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10907 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10908
10909 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10910 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10911
10912 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10913 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10914 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10915
10916 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10917 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10918 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10919 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10920
10921 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10922 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10923 empty input.
10924
10925 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10926 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10927 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10928 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10929 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10930
10931 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10932 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10933 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10934 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10935
10936 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10937 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10938 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10939 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10940 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10941
10942 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10943 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10944 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10945 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10946
10947 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10948 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10949 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10950
10951 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10952 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10953 was directed to display this buffer.
10954
10955 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10956 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10957 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10958 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10959 set-window-configuration.
10960
10961 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10962 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10963 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10964 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10965
10966 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10967 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10968 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10969
10970 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10971 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10972 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10973
10974 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10975 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10976
10977 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10978 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10979
10980 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10981 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10982 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10983
10984 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10985 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10986 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10987 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10988
10989 ** Menu changes
10990
10991 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10992 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
10993 better supported.
10994
10995 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
10996 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
10997 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
10998 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
10999 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11000
11001 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11002
11003 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11004 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11005 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11006 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11007
11008 The format is:
11009 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11010 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11011 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11012 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11013 The supported properties include
11014
11015 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11016 item is enabled.
11017 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11018 item should appear in the menu.
11019 :filter FILTER-FN
11020 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11021 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11022 It should return a binding to use instead.
11023 :keys DESCRIPTION
11024 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11025 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11026 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11027 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11028 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11029 keyboard binding.
11030 :key-sequence nil
11031 This means that the command normally has no
11032 keyboard equivalent.
11033 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11034 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11035 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11036 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11037 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11038
11039 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11040 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11041
11042 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11043
11044 ** New event types
11045
11046 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11047 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11048 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11049 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11050
11051 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11052
11053 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11054 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11055 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11056 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11057 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11058 forward, away from the user.
11059
11060 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11061
11062 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11063 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11064 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11065 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11066 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11067
11068 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11069
11070 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11071 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11072 that were dragged and dropped.
11073
11074 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11075
11076 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11077
11078 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11079 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11080 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11081
11082 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11083 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11084 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11085
11086 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11087 in Emacs 19 and before.
11088
11089 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11090 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11091
11092 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11093 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11094 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11095 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11096
11097 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11098 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11099 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11100 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11101 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11102
11103 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11104 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11105 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11106 consistent with the new representation.
11107
11108 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11109 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11110 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11111 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11112
11113 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11114 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11115 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11116
11117 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11118 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11119 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11120
11121 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11122 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11123 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11124
11125 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11126 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11127
11128 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11129 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11130
11131 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11132 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11133 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11134 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11135
11136 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11137 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11138
11139 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11140 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11141 buffer or string being searched.
11142
11143 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11144 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11145 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11146 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11147 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11148 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11149 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11150
11151 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11152
11153 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11154 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11155 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11156 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11157 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11158 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11159 define-coding-system-alias.
11160
11161 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11162 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11163 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11164 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11165 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11166 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11167 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11168 `iso-8859-1'.
11169
11170 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11171 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11172 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11173 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11174
11175 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11176 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11177 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11178 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11179
11180 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11181 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11182 This function requires a user interaction.
11183
11184 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11185 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11186 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11187 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11188 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11189 select-safe-coding-system.
11190
11191 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11192 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11193 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11194 was done.
11195
11196 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11197 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11198 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11199
11200 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11201 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11202 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11203 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11204
11205 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11206 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11207 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11208 converted.
11209
11210 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11211 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11212
11213 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11214 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11215 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11216 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11217 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11218 range of characters.
11219
11220 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11221 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11222
11223 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11224 in the current buffer at position POS.
11225
11226 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11227 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11228 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11229 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11230 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11231 binding input-method-function to nil.
11232
11233 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11234 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11235 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11236 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11237 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11238
11239 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11240 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11241
11242 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11243 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11244
11245 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11246 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11247 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11248 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11249 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11250 \f
11251 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11252
11253 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11254 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11255 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11256 tree structure.
11257
11258 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11259 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11260
11261 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11262 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11263 in your .emacs file.)
11264
11265 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11266 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11267
11268 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11269 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11270
11271 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11272 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11273 kills the region.
11274
11275 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11276 delete the character before point, as usual.
11277
11278 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11279 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11280 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11281
11282 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11283 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11284 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11285 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11286 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11287 past.)
11288
11289 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11290 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11291 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11292 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11293 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11294
11295 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11296 and is an alias for it.
11297
11298 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11299 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11300
11301 ** Scrolling changes
11302
11303 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11304 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11305
11306 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11307 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11308 where it started.
11309
11310 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11311 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11312 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11313 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11314
11315 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11316 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11317 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11318 recenters the window.
11319
11320 ** International character set support (MULE)
11321
11322 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11323 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11324 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11325 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11326 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11327 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11328
11329 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11330 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11331 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11332 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11333 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11334
11335 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11336 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11337 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11338 language, to make it possible to type them.
11339
11340 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11341 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11342
11343 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11344 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11345
11346 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11347
11348 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11349
11350 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11351 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11352 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11353 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11354 characters for their work until they want to change.
11355
11356 *** Input methods
11357
11358 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11359 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11360 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11361 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11362 support several input methods.
11363
11364 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11365 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11366 work.
11367
11368 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11369 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11370 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11371 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11372 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11373 letter.
11374
11375 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11376 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11377 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11378 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11379 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11380
11381 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11382 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11383 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11384 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11385
11386 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11387 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11388 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11389 the first guess is wrong.
11390
11391 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11392 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11393
11394 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11395 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11396 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11397 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11398
11399 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11400 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11401 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11402 translate automatically to and from either one.
11403
11404 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11405
11406 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11407 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11408 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11409 what you want.
11410
11411 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11412 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11413 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11414 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11415
11416 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11417 character conversion as well.
11418
11419 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11420
11421 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11422 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11423 requires using many fonts.
11424
11425 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11426 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11427
11428 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11429 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11430 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11431 you would use a font.
11432
11433 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11434 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11435 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11436
11437 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11438 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11439 characters).
11440
11441 *** Defining fontsets.
11442
11443 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11444 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11445 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11446
11447 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11448 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11449 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11450 standard fontset are created automatically.
11451
11452 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11453 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11454 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11455 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11456 name is `fontset-startup'.
11457
11458 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11459 The resource value should have this form:
11460 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11461 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11462 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11463 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11464 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11465 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11466 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11467 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11468 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11469
11470 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11471 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11472 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11473
11474 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11475 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11476 following resource,
11477 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11478 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11479 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11480 Here is the substitution rule:
11481 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11482 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11483 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11484 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11485 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11486
11487 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11488 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11489 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11490
11491 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11492 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11493 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11494 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11495 fontsets.
11496
11497 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11498 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11499
11500 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11501 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11502 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11503 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11504 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11505 system for new files that you create.
11506
11507 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11508 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11509 whole Emacs session.
11510
11511 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11512 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11513 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11514
11515 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11516 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11517 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11518 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11519 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11520
11521 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11522 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11523 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11524 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11525 is used for *the immediately following command*.
11526
11527 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11528 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11529
11530 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11531 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11532
11533 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
11534 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11535
11536 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11537 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11538 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11539 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11540 of the file.
11541
11542 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11543 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11544 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11545 translated into that character code.
11546
11547 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11548 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11549
11550 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11551
11552 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11553 the coding system for keyboard input.
11554
11555 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11556 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11557 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11558
11559 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11560
11561 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11562 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11563 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11564 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11565 designed to work with terminals.
11566
11567 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11568 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11569 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11570 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11571 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11572 in the corresponding buffer.
11573
11574 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11575
11576 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11577 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11578 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11579
11580 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11581 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11582 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11583 want to use.
11584
11585 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11586 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11587
11588 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11589 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11590 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11591 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11592
11593 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11594 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11595 related information.
11596
11597 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11598 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11599 scripts.
11600
11601 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11602 information about the support for a particular language.
11603 You specify the language as an argument.
11604
11605 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11606 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11607 first dash.
11608
11609 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11610 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11611 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
11612 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11613
11614 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11615 B big5 (Chinese)
11616 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11617 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11618 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11619 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11620 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11621 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11622 K euc-korea (Korean)
11623 R koi8 (Russian)
11624 Q tibetan
11625 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11626 T lao
11627 T tis620 (Thai)
11628 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11629 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11630 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11631 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11632 z hz (Chinese)
11633
11634 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11635 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11636 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11637 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11638
11639 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11640 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11641
11642 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11643 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11644 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11645 Rmail files themselves.
11646
11647 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11648 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11649
11650 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11651 for sending mail:
11652
11653 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11654 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11655 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11656 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11657 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11658
11659 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11660 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11661 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11662 translations.
11663
11664 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11665 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11666 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11667 without any conversion.
11668
11669 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11670 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11671 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11672 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11673
11674 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11675 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11676
11677 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11678 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11679
11680 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11681 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11682
11683 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11684 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11685 in the buffer before point.
11686
11687 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11688 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11689 you are using.
11690
11691 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11692 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11693
11694 ** File locking works with NFS now.
11695
11696 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11697 in the same directory as FILENAME.
11698
11699 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11700 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11701 can become a bottleneck.
11702
11703 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11704 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11705 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11706 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11707 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11708 so useful that the change is worth while.
11709
11710 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11711 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11712 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11713 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11714
11715 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11716 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11717 show-paren-mode.
11718
11719 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11720 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11721 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11722
11723 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11724 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11725 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11726
11727 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11728 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11729 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11730
11731 ** Changes in View mode.
11732
11733 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11734 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11735
11736 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11737 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11738
11739 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11740 previous state.
11741
11742 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11743 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11744
11745 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11746 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11747 not just the selected window.
11748
11749 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11750 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11751 turns View mode on or off.
11752
11753 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11754 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11755 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11756
11757 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11758 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11759
11760 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11761 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11762 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11763 which version to compare with.
11764
11765 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11766 blocks if a match is inside the block.
11767
11768 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11769 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11770 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11771 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11772
11773 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11774 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11775 blocks, all of them or none.
11776
11777 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11778 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11779 confirmation first.
11780
11781 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11782 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11783 However, the mode will not be changed if
11784 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11785 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11786 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11787 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11788
11789 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11790
11791 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11792 these commands do not change the major mode.
11793
11794 ** M-x occur changes.
11795
11796 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11797 it performs a case-sensitive search.
11798
11799 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11800 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11801 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11802
11803 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11804 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11805 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11806 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11807 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11808
11809 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11810 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11811 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11812 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11813
11814 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11815 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11816 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11817
11818 ** Outline mode changes.
11819
11820 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11821
11822 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11823
11824 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11825 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11826 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11827 was already active.
11828
11829 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11830 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11831 get confused by it.
11832
11833 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11834 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11835
11836 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11837
11838 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11839 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11840 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11841 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11842
11843 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11844 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11845 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11846
11847 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11848 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11849 values.
11850
11851 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11852 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11853 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11854 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11855
11856 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11857 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11858 can be. The default value is 30.
11859
11860 ** Changes in Mail mode.
11861
11862 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11863 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11864 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11865 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11866 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11867 behavior.
11868
11869 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11870 compose-mail-other-frame.
11871
11872 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11873 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11874 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11875 buffer that shows the original message.
11876
11877 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11878 with separator lines around the contents.
11879
11880 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11881 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11882 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11883 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11884
11885 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
11886
11887 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11888 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11889 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11890 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11891
11892 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11893 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11894 /etc/passwd.
11895
11896 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11897 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11898 /etc/passwd.
11899
11900 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11901 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11902 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11903 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11904
11905 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11906 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11907 be taken to be magic.
11908
11909 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11910 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11911 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11912
11913 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11914 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11915
11916 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11917 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11918
11919 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11920
11921 new key dired.el binding old key
11922 ------- ---------------- -------
11923 * c dired-change-marks c
11924 * m dired-mark m
11925 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11926 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11927 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11928 * u dired-unmark u
11929 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
11930 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
11931 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11932 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11933 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11934 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11935
11936 ** Rmail changes.
11937
11938 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11939 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11940 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11941 each time you run it.
11942
11943 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11944 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11945
11946 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11947 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11948 means to move in the opposite direction.
11949
11950 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11951 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11952
11953 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11954 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11955 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11956 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11957 for output.
11958
11959 ** Gnus changes.
11960
11961 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11962
11963 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11964 Gnus.
11965
11966 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11967 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11968
11969 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11970 article mode line.
11971
11972 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11973
11974 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11975
11976 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11977
11978 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11979 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11980 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11981
11982 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11983
11984 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11985
11986 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11987 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11988
11989 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11990 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11991 used to pick articles.
11992
11993 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
11994 another have been added.
11995
11996 `M-x gnus-change-server'
11997
11998 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
11999 generating lines in buffers.
12000
12001 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12002 `C-M-_'.
12003
12004 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12005
12006 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12007
12008 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12009
12010 *** Scores can be decayed.
12011
12012 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12013
12014 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12015 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12016
12017 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12018 the native server.
12019
12020 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12021
12022 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12023 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12024
12025 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12026
12027 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12028 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12029
12030 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12031 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12032
12033 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12034 a group.
12035
12036 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12037 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12038
12039 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12040
12041 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12042
12043 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12044
12045 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12046
12047 Use the `Y c' command.
12048
12049 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12050
12051 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12052
12053 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12054
12055 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12056 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12057
12058 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12059
12060 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12061
12062 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12063 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12064
12065 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12066
12067 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12068 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12069 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12070 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12071 this issue.)
12072
12073 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12074 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12075 particular news group. This can be done by:
12076
12077 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12078
12079 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12080 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12081 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12082 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12083 for reading and posting).
12084
12085 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12086 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12087 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12088 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12089 there.
12090
12091 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12092 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12093
12094 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12095 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12096 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12097 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12098 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12099
12100 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12101 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12102
12103 ** CC mode changes.
12104
12105 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12106 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12107 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12108 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12109 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12110 loaded.
12111
12112 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12113 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12114 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12115 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12116 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12117 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12118
12119 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12120 of the current buffer.
12121
12122 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12123 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12124 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12125
12126 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12127 style that the Python developers like.
12128
12129 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12130 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12131 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12132
12133 ** VC Changes [new]
12134
12135 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12136 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12137 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12138
12139 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12140 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12141 developers.
12142
12143 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12144 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12145
12146 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12147 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12148 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12149 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12150
12151 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12152 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12153
12154 ** Calendar changes.
12155
12156 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12157 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12158 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12159 following/previous years.
12160
12161 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12162 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12163 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12164 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12165 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12166 supposed attribute of God.
12167
12168 ** ps-print changes
12169
12170 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12171 layout.
12172
12173 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12174
12175 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12176 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12177 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12178 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12179
12180 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12181 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12182 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12183
12184 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12185 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12186
12187 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12188 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12189 printing for your printer.
12190
12191 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12192 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12193
12194 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12195 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12196
12197 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12198 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12199 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12200 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12201 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12202 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12203 The default value is nil.
12204
12205 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12206 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12207
12208 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12209 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12210 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12211 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12212 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12213 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12214 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12215
12216 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12217 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12218
12219 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12220 The default is 0 ("black").
12221
12222 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12223 The default is 0 ("black").
12224
12225 border-width Specify the border width.
12226 The default is 0.4.
12227
12228 Any other property is ignored.
12229
12230 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12231 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12232 documentation).
12233
12234 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12235 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12236 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12237 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12238 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12239 controlling headers.
12240
12241 *** Color management (subgroup)
12242
12243 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12244 color.
12245
12246 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12247
12248 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12249 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12250 background should be used. Valid values are:
12251
12252 t always use face background color.
12253 nil never use face background color.
12254 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12255
12256 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12257
12258 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12259 sheet of paper.
12260
12261 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12262 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12263
12264 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12265 each page.
12266
12267 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12268 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12269 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12270
12271 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12272 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12273 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12274
12275 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12276 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12277 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12278
12279 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12280 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12281 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12282
12283 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12284 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12285 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12286
12287 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12288
12289 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12290
12291 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12292 RGB color.
12293
12294 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12295 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12296 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12297
12298 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12299 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12300 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12301 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12302 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12303 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12304 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12305 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12306 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12307 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12308 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12309 10 + 10 +
12310 11 + 11 +
12311 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12312 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12313 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12314 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12315 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12316 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12317 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12318 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12319 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12320 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12321 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12322 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12323 22 + 22 +
12324 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12325
12326 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12327
12328
12329 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12330
12331 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12332 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12333 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12334 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12335 to "-P".
12336
12337 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12338 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12339 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12340
12341 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12342 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12343 do so.
12344
12345 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12346
12347 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12348 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12349 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12350 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12351 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12352 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12353 `setpagedevice'.
12354
12355 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12356 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12357 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12358
12359 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12360 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12361 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12362 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12363 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12364 its TO, are ignored.
12365
12366 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12367 pages. Valid values are:
12368
12369 nil print all pages.
12370
12371 `even-page' print only even pages.
12372
12373 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12374
12375 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12376 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12377 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12378 print only the even sheet of paper.
12379
12380 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12381 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12382 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12383 only the odd sheet of paper.
12384
12385 Any other value is treated as nil.
12386
12387 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12388 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12389 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12390
12391 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12392
12393 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12394 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12395
12396 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12397 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12398 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12399 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12400 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12401 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12402 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12403
12404 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12405 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12406 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12407 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12408 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12409 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12410 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12411
12412 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12413
12414 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12415 messages should be sent.
12416
12417 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12418 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12419 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12420
12421 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12422
12423 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12424 points for line numbers.
12425
12426 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12427 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12428
12429 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12430 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12431 to 2, the printing will look like:
12432
12433 1 one line
12434 one line
12435 3 one line
12436 one line
12437 5 one line
12438 one line
12439 ...
12440
12441 Valid values are:
12442
12443 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12444 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12445 is used.
12446
12447 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12448 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12449
12450 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12451
12452 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12453 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12454 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12455 3, the output will look like:
12456
12457 one line
12458 one line
12459 3 one line
12460 one line
12461 one line
12462 6 one line
12463 one line
12464 one line
12465 9 one line
12466 one line
12467 ...
12468
12469 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12470 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12471
12472 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12473 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12474 `ps-font-size').
12475
12476 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12477 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12478 `ps-font-size').
12479
12480 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12481
12482 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12483 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12484
12485 ** hideshow changes.
12486
12487 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12488 C++, ; for lisp).
12489
12490 *** Support for java-mode added.
12491
12492 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12493 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12494
12495 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12496 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12497 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12498
12499 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12500 robust and a lot faster.
12501
12502 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12503
12504 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12505 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12506 documentation for more details.
12507
12508 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12509
12510 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12511 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12512 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12513 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12514 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12515
12516 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12517 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12518 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12519 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12520
12521 ** Font Lock mode
12522
12523 *** Custom support
12524
12525 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12526 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12527 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12528 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12529 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12530 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12531
12532 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12533
12534 *** Maximum decoration
12535
12536 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12537 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12538 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12539 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12540 to get the old behavior.
12541
12542 *** New support
12543
12544 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12545
12546 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12547 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12548
12549 *** Configurable support
12550
12551 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12552 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12553 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12554 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12555 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12556 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12557 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12558
12559 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12560 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12561 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12562
12563 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12564
12565 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12566 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12567 for any mode.
12568
12569 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12570
12571 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12572
12573 in your ~/.emacs.
12574
12575 *** New faces
12576
12577 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12578 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12579 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12580 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12581
12582 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12583
12584 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12585 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12586 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12587
12588 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12589
12590 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12591 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12592 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12593 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12594 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12595 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
12596 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
12597
12598 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12599 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12600 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12601 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12602 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12603 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12604
12605 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12606
12607 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12608 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12609 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12610 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12611
12612 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12613 settings.
12614
12615 ** Ada mode changes.
12616
12617 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12618 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12619 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12620 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12621 stubs.
12622
12623 *** There are two new commands:
12624 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12625 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12626
12627 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12628 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12629 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12630
12631 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12632 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12633 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12634
12635 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12636 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12637 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12638 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12639
12640 ** Scheme mode changes.
12641
12642 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12643 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12644 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12645 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12646 have any effect.
12647
12648 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12649 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12650 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12651 variables as buffer-local variables.
12652
12653 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12654 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12655
12656 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
12657
12658 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12659 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12660 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12661 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12662
12663 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12664 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12665 buffer in Emacs.
12666
12667 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12668 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12669 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12670 option takes precedence.
12671
12672 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12673 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12674 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12675
12676 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12677 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12678 the current defun.
12679
12680 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12681 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12682
12683 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12684 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12685 necessary).
12686
12687 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12688 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12689 these register values no longer become completely useless.
12690 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12691 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12692 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12693
12694 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12695 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12696 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12697 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12698
12699 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12700 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12701 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12702 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12703 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12704
12705 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12706 since it applies only to the current frame.
12707
12708 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12709 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12710 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12711
12712 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12713 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12714 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12715 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12716 instead of just the file you are editing.
12717
12718 ** RefTeX mode
12719
12720 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12721 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12722 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12723 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12724 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12725
12726 C-c ( reftex-label
12727 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12728 knows which kind of label is needed.
12729
12730 C-c ) reftex-reference
12731 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12732 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12733
12734 C-c [ reftex-citation
12735 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12736 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12737
12738 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12739 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12740
12741 C-c = reftex-toc
12742 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12743 can quickly jump to every section.
12744
12745 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12746 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12747 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12748 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12749 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12750
12751 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12752
12753 *** Info documentation is now available.
12754
12755 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12756 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12757
12758 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12759 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12760
12761 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12762 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12763
12764 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12765 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12766 appropriate functions.
12767
12768 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
12769 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
12770
12771 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12772 been cleaned.
12773
12774 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12775 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12776
12777 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12778 shall be delimited.
12779
12780 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12781 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12782 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12783
12784 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12785 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12786 prefixed with `ALT'.
12787
12788 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12789 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12790 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12791 documentation).
12792
12793 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12794 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12795 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12796
12797 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12798 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12799
12800 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12801 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12802 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12803
12804 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12805
12806 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12807
12808 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12809 from alien sources.
12810
12811 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12812 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12813 crossref entries.
12814
12815 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12816 region.
12817
12818 *** Added support for imenu.
12819
12820 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12821 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12822 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12823 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12824
12825 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12826 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12827
12828 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12829
12830 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12831
12832 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12833 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12834 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12835 as an argument.
12836
12837 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12838 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12839
12840 ** browse-url changes
12841
12842 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12843 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12844 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12845 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12846 customization variables.
12847
12848 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12849
12850 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12851 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12852 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12853
12854 ** Changes in Ediff
12855
12856 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12857 pops up the Info file for this command.
12858
12859 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12860 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12861 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12862 directories).
12863
12864 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12865 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12866 files in the same directory.
12867
12868 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12869 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12870 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12871
12872 ** Changes in Viper
12873
12874 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12875 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12876 instead of vip-.
12877 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12878 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12879 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12880 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12881 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12882 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12883 color when Viper is in insert state.
12884 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12885 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12886 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12887
12888 ** Etags changes.
12889
12890 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12891 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12892 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12893 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12894 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12895
12896 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12897
12898 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12899 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12900
12901 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12902 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12903 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12904
12905 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12906 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12907 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12908 methods and protocols.
12909
12910 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12911 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12912 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12913 paragraph name.
12914
12915 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12916 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12917 at least M times and as many as N times.
12918
12919 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12920 in files has changed slightly.
12921
12922 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12923 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12924 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12925 with old time-stamp-format values.
12926
12927 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12928 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12929 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12930 reasons.
12931
12932 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12933 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12934 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12935 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12936 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12937 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12938
12939 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12940 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12941 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12942
12943 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12944 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12945 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12946 recommended now will continue to work then.
12947
12948 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12949 details.
12950
12951 ** There are some additional major modes:
12952
12953 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12954 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12955 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12956
12957 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12958 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12959 into Emacs.
12960
12961 ** New Lisp packages include:
12962
12963 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12964
12965 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12966 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12967
12968 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12969
12970 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12971 in shell buffers.
12972
12973 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12974 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12975 and `elint-defun'.
12976
12977 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12978 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12979 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12980 strings or comments.
12981
12982 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12983 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12984 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12985 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12986 at these points.
12987
12988 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12989 can visit them by short forms of their names.
12990
12991 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12992 Emacs Lisp function at point.
12993
12994 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
12995
12996 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
12997 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
12998
12999 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13000
13001 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13002
13003 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13004
13005 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13006 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13007
13008 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13009 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13010 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13011 original place after inserting the copy.
13012
13013 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13014 on the buffer.
13015
13016 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13017 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13018 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13019
13020 Enable mouse-drag with:
13021 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13022 -or-
13023 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13024
13025 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13026 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13027
13028 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13029 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13030
13031 *** ogonek
13032
13033 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13034 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13035 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13036 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13037 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13038 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13039 instance) and vice versa.
13040
13041 To use this package load it using
13042 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13043 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13044 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13045 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13046 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13047 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13048
13049 *** Interface to ph.
13050
13051 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13052
13053 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13054 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13055 these servers.
13056
13057 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13058
13059 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13060 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13061 while the real cursor does not move.
13062
13063 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13064 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13065
13066 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13067 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13068
13069 ** movemail change
13070
13071 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13072 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13073 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13074 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13075
13076 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13077 \f
13078 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13079
13080 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13081
13082 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13083 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13084 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13085 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13086 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13087
13088 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13089 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13090 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13091 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13092 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13093 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13094 \f
13095 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13096
13097 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13098 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13099 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13100 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13101
13102 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13103 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13104
13105 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13106 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13107 "win".
13108
13109 ** Basic Lisp changes
13110
13111 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13112 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13113
13114 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13115 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13116 or by the user.
13117
13118 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13119
13120 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13121
13122 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13123 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13124
13125 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13126 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13127 its argument.
13128
13129 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13130
13131 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13132
13133 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13134
13135 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13136 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13137 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13138 `format' function.
13139
13140 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13141 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13142 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13143
13144 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13145 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13146 adding one of these suffixes.
13147
13148 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13149 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13150 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13151
13152 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13153 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13154
13155 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13156
13157 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13158 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13159
13160 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13161 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13162
13163 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13164
13165 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13166 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13167
13168 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13169 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13170 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13171 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13172
13173 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13174 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13175 of the last form.
13176
13177 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13178 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13179 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13180 as the last form.
13181
13182 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13183 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13184 matches.
13185
13186 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13187
13188 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13189 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13190 Then it returns that string.
13191
13192 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13193
13194 (with-output-to-string
13195 (princ "The buffer is ")
13196 (princ (buffer-name)))
13197
13198 returns "The buffer is foo".
13199
13200 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13201 is non-nil.
13202
13203 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13204 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13205 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13206
13207 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13208 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13209
13210 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13211 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13212 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13213 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13214 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13215 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13216
13217 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13218 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13219 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13220 characters".
13221
13222 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13223 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13224 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13225 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13226 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13227
13228 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13229 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13230 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13231 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13232
13233 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13234 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13235
13236 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13237
13238 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13239 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13240 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13241 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13242 guaranteed.
13243
13244 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13245 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13246 character).
13247
13248 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13249
13250 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13251 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13252 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13253 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13254 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13255
13256 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13257
13258 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13259 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13260 more than the number of characters.
13261
13262 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13263 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13264 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13265 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13266 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13267 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13268
13269 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13270 and returns a string containing those characters.
13271
13272 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13273 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13274 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13275 character, sref signals an error.
13276
13277 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13278 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13279 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13280
13281 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13282 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13283 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13284
13285 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13286 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13287 to a vector of the characters in it.
13288
13289 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13290 of a string. You call it as follows:
13291
13292 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13293
13294 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13295 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13296 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13297 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13298 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13299
13300 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13301 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13302
13303 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13304 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13305
13306 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13307 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13308 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13309 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13310
13311 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13312
13313 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13314
13315 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13316 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13317 are not included in the resulting value.
13318
13319 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13320 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13321 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13322 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13323
13324 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13325 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13326 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13327 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13328 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13329 column START-COLUMN.
13330
13331 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13332 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13333 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13334 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13335 changed text, before the change.
13336
13337 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13338 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13339 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13340
13341 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13342
13343 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13344
13345 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13346 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13347
13348 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13349 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13350 which identify the character within that character set.
13351
13352 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13353 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13354 opposite of split-char.
13355
13356 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13357 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13358
13359 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13360 of all the characters in a string.
13361
13362 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13363 and specifying coding systems.
13364
13365 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13366 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13367 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13368 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13369 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13370 as what to do about code conversion.)
13371
13372 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13373 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13374
13375 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13376 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13377 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13378
13379 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13380 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13381 to match against a file name.
13382
13383 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13384 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13385 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13386 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13387 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13388 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13389
13390 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13391 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13392
13393 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13394 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13395
13396 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13397 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13398 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13399 service names.
13400
13401 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13402 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13403 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13404 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13405 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13406 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13407
13408 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13409 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13410
13411 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13412 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13413 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13414 start the subprocess.
13415
13416 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13417 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13418 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13419 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13420 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13421
13422 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13423 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13424 subprocess.
13425
13426 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13427 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13428 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13429 connection permanently or until overridden.
13430
13431 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13432 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13433 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13434 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13435 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13436 system for one operation at a time.
13437
13438 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13439 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13440
13441 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13442 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13443 The value is a cons cell,
13444 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13445 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13446 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13447 input to the subprocess.
13448
13449 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13450 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13451
13452 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13453 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13454 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13455
13456 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13457 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13458 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13459 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13460 customization.
13461
13462 Thus, instead of writing
13463
13464 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13465 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13466
13467 you would now write this:
13468
13469 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13470 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13471 :type 'boolean
13472 :group foo)
13473
13474 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13475 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13476 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13477 for a description of them.
13478
13479 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13480 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13481
13482 (defgroup ispell nil
13483 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13484 :group 'processes)
13485
13486 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13487 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13488 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13489 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13490 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13491
13492 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13493 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13494 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13495 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13496 first-level subgroups.
13497
13498 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13499
13500 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13501 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13502
13503 ** easy-mmode
13504
13505 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13506 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13507 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13508 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13509 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13510 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13511
13512 ** Text property changes
13513
13514 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13515 text property.
13516
13517 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13518 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13519 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13520 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13521 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13522
13523 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13524 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13525 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13526 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13527
13528 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13529 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13530 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13531
13532 ** Changes in invisibility features
13533
13534 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13535 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13536 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13537 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13538 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13539 make the overlay visible.
13540
13541 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13542 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13543 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13544 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13545 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13546 t when it should hide it.
13547
13548 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13549
13550 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13551 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13552 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13553 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13554 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13555 Here is an example of how to do this:
13556
13557 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13558 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13559 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13560 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13561
13562 ...
13563 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13564
13565 ...
13566 ;; When done with the overlays:
13567 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13568 ;; Or respectively:
13569 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13570
13571 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
13572
13573 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13574 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13575 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13576 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13577
13578 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13579 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13580 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13581
13582 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13583 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13584
13585 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13586 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13587
13588 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13589 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13590 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13591
13592 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13593 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13594 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13595 determine the syntax type of the character.
13596
13597 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13598 of the current buffer.
13599
13600 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13601 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13602 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13603
13604 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13605 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13606 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13607 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13608 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13609
13610 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13611 text property.
13612
13613 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13614 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13615 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13616
13617 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13618 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13619 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13620 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13621 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13622
13623 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13624 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13625 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13626
13627 ** Changes in face features
13628
13629 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13630 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13631
13632 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13633 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13634
13635 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13636 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13637
13638 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13639 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13640
13641 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13642 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13643 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13644 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13645 overlay property).
13646
13647 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13648 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13649
13650 ** Changes in file-handling functions
13651
13652 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13653 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13654 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13655 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13656
13657 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13658 begins with ~.
13659
13660 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13661 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13662
13663 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13664 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13665
13666 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13667 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13668
13669 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13670 character code conversion as well as other things.
13671
13672 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13673 (formerly it did not).
13674
13675 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13676 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13677
13678 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13679 instead of constant strings.
13680
13681 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13682 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13683 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13684
13685 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13686 in the same way as before.
13687
13688 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13689 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13690 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13691
13692 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13693 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13694 else, and returns nil.
13695
13696 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13697 directory cannot be listed.
13698
13699 ** Changes in minibuffer input
13700
13701 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13702 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13703 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13704 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13705 ways:
13706
13707 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13708 It is available through the history command M-n.
13709
13710 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13711 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13712 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13713 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13714 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13715
13716 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13717 argument in this way.
13718
13719 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13720 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13721 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13722
13723 ** Echo area features
13724
13725 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13726 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13727 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13728 after the echo area is cleared.
13729
13730 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13731 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13732
13733 ** Keyboard input features
13734
13735 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13736 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13737
13738 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13739 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13740 by keyboard macros.
13741
13742 ** Frame-related changes
13743
13744 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13745 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13746 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13747
13748 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13749 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13750 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13751
13752 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13753 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13754 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13755 in the selected frame.
13756
13757 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13758 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13759 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13760
13761 ** X Windows features
13762
13763 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13764 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13765 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13766
13767 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13768 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13769
13770 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13771 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13772 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13773
13774 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13775 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13776
13777 ** Subprocess features
13778
13779 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13780 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13781 automatically.
13782
13783 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13784 and returns the output from the command as a string.
13785
13786 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13787 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13788
13789 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13790 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13791
13792 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13793 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13794 goes after the other menu items.
13795
13796 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13797 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13798 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13799 are in use.
13800
13801 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13802 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13803
13804 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13805 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13806 form.
13807
13808 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13809 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13810 but its hook is still run.
13811
13812 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13813 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13814
13815 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13816 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13817 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13818
13819 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13820 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13821 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13822 warned.
13823
13824 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13825 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13826
13827 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13828 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13829 functions like display-time.
13830
13831 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13832 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13833
13834 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13835 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13836 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13837
13838 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13839 if there is an error in compilation.
13840
13841 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13842 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13843 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13844 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13845
13846 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13847 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13848 the *scratch* buffer.
13849
13850 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13851 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13852 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13853 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13854
13855 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13856 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13857 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13858
13859 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13860 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13861 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13862 and compose-mail-other-frame.
13863
13864 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13865 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13866 full name of the specified user will be returned.
13867
13868 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13869 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13870 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13871 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13872 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13873 files at all.
13874
13875 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13876 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13877 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13878 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13879
13880 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13881 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13882 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13883 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13884
13885 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13886
13887 ** imenu.el changes.
13888
13889 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13890 item from menu created by imenu.
13891
13892 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13893 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13894 select one of those items.
13895 \f
13896 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
13897
13898 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
13899 Copyright information:
13900
13901 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13902
13903 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13904 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13905 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13906 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13907
13908 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13909 of this document, or of portions of it,
13910 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13911 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
13912 \f
13913 Local variables:
13914 mode: outline
13915 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13916 end:
13917
13918 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793